blob: 0528a58f894445da97e9b2b3887c7101bad76cbb [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000032#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000033#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000034#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000035#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000038#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000039#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000040#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000041#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000042
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000043using namespace clang;
44
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000045unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
46unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000047unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
48unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000049unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
50unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000051unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
52unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000053unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
54unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000055unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
56unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
57
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000058enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000059 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000060};
61
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000062RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000063 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
64 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
65 CommentsLoaded = true;
66 }
67
68 assert(D);
69
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000070 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
71 if (D->isImplicit())
72 return NULL;
73
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000074 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
75 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
76 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
77 return NULL;
78 }
79
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000080 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
81 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
82 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
83 return NULL;
84 }
85
86 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
87 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
88 return NULL;
89 }
90
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000091 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
92 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
93 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
94 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
95 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
96 return NULL;
97 }
98
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000099 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
100 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
101 return NULL;
102 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000103 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
104 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
105 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
106 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
107 return NULL;
108 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000109 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
110 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
111 return NULL;
112
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000113 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
114 // documentation.
115 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
116 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
117 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
118 return NULL;
119
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000120 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000121
122 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
123 if (RawComments.empty())
124 return NULL;
125
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000126 // Find declaration location.
127 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
128 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
129 // location".
130 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
131 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
132 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
133 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000134 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000135 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
136 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000137 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000138 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000139 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000140 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
141 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location
142 // as the "declaration location".
143 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID() && isa<TypedefDecl>(D))
144 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
145 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000146
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000147 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
148 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000149 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
150 return NULL;
151
152 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000153 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
154 {
155 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
156 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
157 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000158 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
159 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
160 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000161 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
162 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
163 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
164 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
165 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
166 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
167 }
168
169 if (Found) {
170 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
171 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
172 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
173 } else {
174 // Slow path.
175 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
176 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
177 }
178 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000179
180 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
181 // file buffer.
182 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
183
184 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
185 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000186 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000187 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000188 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000189 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000190 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000191 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
192 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
193 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
194 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
195 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
196 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000197 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000198 }
199 }
200
201 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
202 // Let's look at the previous comment.
203 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
204 return NULL;
205 --Comment;
206
207 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000208 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 return NULL;
210
211 // Decompose the end of the comment.
212 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000213 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000214
215 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
216 // aren't related.
217 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
218 return NULL;
219
220 // Get the corresponding buffer.
221 bool Invalid = false;
222 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
223 &Invalid).data();
224 if (Invalid)
225 return NULL;
226
227 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
228 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
229 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
230
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000231 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
232 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000233 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234 return NULL;
235
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000236 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000237}
238
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000239namespace {
240/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
241/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000242/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000243const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000244 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000245 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000246 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000247 return FTD;
248
249 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
250 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
251 return D;
252
253 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
254 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
255 return FTD;
256
257 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
258 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
259 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
260 return MemberDecl;
261
262 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000263 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000264 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
265 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
266 // template?
267 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
268 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
269 return MemberDecl;
270
271 return D;
272 }
273 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
274 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
275 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
276 return CTD;
277
278 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
279 // specialization?
280 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
281 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
282 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
283 return D;
284 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
285 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
286 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
287 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
288 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
289 static_cast<const Decl*>(
290 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
291 }
292
293 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
294 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
295 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
296 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
297
298 return D;
299 }
300 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
301 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
302 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
303 return MemberDecl;
304
305 return D;
306 }
307 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000308 return D;
309}
310} // unnamed namespace
311
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000312const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
313 const Decl *D,
314 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000315 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000316
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000317 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
318 {
319 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
320 RedeclComments.find(D);
321 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
322 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000323 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
324 if (OriginalDecl)
325 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000326 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000327 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000328 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000329 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000330
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000331 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
332 const RawComment *RC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000333 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000334 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
335 E = D->redecls_end();
336 I != E; ++I) {
337 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
338 RedeclComments.find(*I);
339 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
340 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
341 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
342 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000344 break;
345 }
346 } else {
347 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(*I);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000348 OriginalDeclForRC = *I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000349 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
350 if (RC) {
351 Raw.setRaw(RC);
352 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
353 } else
354 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000355 Raw.setOriginalDecl(*I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000356 RedeclComments[*I] = Raw;
357 if (RC)
358 break;
359 }
360 }
361
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000362 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
363 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000364
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000365 if (OriginalDecl)
366 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
367
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000368 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
369 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
370 Raw.setRaw(RC);
371 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000372 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000373
374 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
375 E = D->redecls_end();
376 I != E; ++I) {
377 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[*I];
378 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
379 R = Raw;
380 }
381
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000382 return RC;
383}
384
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000385static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
386 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
387 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
388 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
389 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
390 if (!ID)
391 return;
392 // Add redeclared method here.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000393 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
394 Ext = ID->known_extensions_begin(),
395 ExtEnd = ID->known_extensions_end();
396 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000397 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000398 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000399 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
400 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
401 }
402 }
403}
404
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000405comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
406 const Decl *D) const {
407 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
408 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
409 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
410 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
411 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
412 comments::FullComment *CFC =
413 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
414 ThisDeclInfo);
415 return CFC;
416
417}
418
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000419comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
420 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
421 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, 0, D) : 0;
422}
423
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000424comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
425 const Decl *D,
426 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000427 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
428 return NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000429 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000430
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000431 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
432 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
433 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000434
435 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000436 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000437 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000438 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000439 return CFC;
440 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000441 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000442 }
443
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000444 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000446 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000447 if (!RC) {
448 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000449 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000450 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000451 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
452 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
453 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
454 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000455 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000456 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
457 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000458 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
459 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
460 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000461 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000462 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000463 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000464 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000465 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000466 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
467 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000470 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000471 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
472 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
473 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
476 }
477 }
478 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
479 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
480 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
481 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
482 }
483 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
484 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
485 return NULL;
486 // Check non-virtual bases.
487 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
488 RD->bases_begin(), E = RD->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000489 if (I->isVirtual() || (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000490 continue;
491 QualType Ty = I->getType();
492 if (Ty.isNull())
493 continue;
494 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
495 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
496 continue;
497
498 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
499 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
500 }
501 }
502 // Check virtual bases.
503 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
504 RD->vbases_begin(), E = RD->vbases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000505 if (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
506 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000507 QualType Ty = I->getType();
508 if (Ty.isNull())
509 continue;
510 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
511 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
512 continue;
513 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
514 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
515 }
516 }
517 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000518 return NULL;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000519 }
520
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000521 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
522 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
523 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
524 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000525 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000526 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000527
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000528 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000529 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
530 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000531}
532
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000533void
534ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
535 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
536 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
537 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000538 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000539
540 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
541 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
542 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
543 PEnd = Params->end();
544 P != PEnd; ++P) {
545 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
546 ID.AddInteger(0);
547 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
548 continue;
549 }
550
551 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
552 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000553 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000554 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000555 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
556 ID.AddBoolean(true);
557 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000558 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
559 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
560 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
561 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000562 } else
563 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000564 continue;
565 }
566
567 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
568 ID.AddInteger(2);
569 Profile(ID, TTP);
570 }
571}
572
573TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
574ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000575 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000576 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
577 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
578 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
579 void *InsertPos = 0;
580 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
581 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
582 if (Canonical)
583 return Canonical->getParam();
584
585 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
586 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000587 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000588 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
589 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
590 PEnd = Params->end();
591 P != PEnd; ++P) {
592 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
593 CanonParams.push_back(
594 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000595 SourceLocation(),
596 SourceLocation(),
597 TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000598 TTP->getIndex(), 0, false,
599 TTP->isParameterPack()));
600 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000601 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
602 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
603 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
604 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
605 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000606 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
607 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000608 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
609 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
610 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
611 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
612 }
613
614 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000615 SourceLocation(),
616 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000617 NTTP->getDepth(),
618 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
619 T,
620 TInfo,
621 ExpandedTypes.data(),
622 ExpandedTypes.size(),
623 ExpandedTInfos.data());
624 } else {
625 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000626 SourceLocation(),
627 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000628 NTTP->getDepth(),
629 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
630 T,
631 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
632 TInfo);
633 }
634 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
635
636 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000637 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
638 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
639 }
640
641 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
642 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
643 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000644 TTP->getPosition(),
645 TTP->isParameterPack(),
646 0,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000647 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
648 SourceLocation(),
649 CanonParams.data(),
650 CanonParams.size(),
651 SourceLocation()));
652
653 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
654 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
655 assert(Canonical == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
656 (void)Canonical;
657
658 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
659 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
660 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
661 return CanonTTP;
662}
663
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000664CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000665 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return 0;
666
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000667 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
668 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
669 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000670 return CreateARMCXXABI(*this);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +0000671 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000672 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000673 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000674 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000675 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
676 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000677 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000678}
679
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000680static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000681 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
682 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
683 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
684 // language-specific address space.
685 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
686 1, // opencl_global
687 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000688 3, // opencl_constant
689 4, // cuda_device
690 5, // cuda_constant
691 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000692 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000695 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000696 }
697}
698
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000699static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
700 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
701 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000702 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
703 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
704 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
705 return true;
706 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
707 return false;
708 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000709 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000710}
711
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000712ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000713 const TargetInfo *t,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000714 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +0000715 Builtin::Context &builtins,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000716 unsigned size_reserve,
717 bool DelayInitialization)
718 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
719 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
720 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
721 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
722 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(0),
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000723 Int128Decl(0), UInt128Decl(0), Float128StubDecl(0),
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +0000724 BuiltinVaListDecl(0),
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +0000725 ObjCIdDecl(0), ObjCSelDecl(0), ObjCClassDecl(0), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(0),
Fariborz Jahanianf2578572012-08-30 18:49:41 +0000726 BOOLDecl(0),
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +0000727 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(0), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(0),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728 FILEDecl(0),
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +0000729 jmp_bufDecl(0), sigjmp_bufDecl(0), ucontext_tDecl(0),
730 BlockDescriptorType(0), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(0),
731 cudaConfigureCallDecl(0),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000732 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
733 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000734 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000735 AddrSpaceMap(0), Target(t), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000736 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
737 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
738 DeclarationNames(*this),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000739 ExternalSource(0), Listener(0),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000740 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000741 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Rafael Espindolace2168f2013-05-29 19:51:12 +0000742 LastSDM(0, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000743{
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000744 if (size_reserve > 0) Types.reserve(size_reserve);
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000745 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000746
747 if (!DelayInitialization) {
748 assert(t && "No target supplied for ASTContext initialization");
749 InitBuiltinTypes(*t);
750 }
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000751}
752
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000753ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000754 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
755 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
756 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000757
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000758 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
759 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
760 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
761 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
762 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
763
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000764 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000765 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
766 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
767 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
768 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
769 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
770 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
771 R->Destroy(*this);
772
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000773 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000779
780 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
781 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
782 A != AEnd; ++A)
783 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000784
785 for (llvm::DenseMap<const DeclContext *, MangleNumberingContext *>::iterator
786 I = MangleNumberingContexts.begin(),
787 E = MangleNumberingContexts.end();
788 I != E; ++I)
789 delete I->second;
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000790}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000791
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000792void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000793 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000794}
795
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000796void
Dylan Noblesmithe2778992012-02-05 02:12:40 +0000797ASTContext::setExternalSource(OwningPtr<ExternalASTSource> &Source) {
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000798 ExternalSource.reset(Source.take());
799}
800
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000801void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000802 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
803 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000804
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000805 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000806#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000807#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
808#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
809 0 // Extra
810 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000811
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000812 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
813 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000814 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000815 }
816
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000817 unsigned Idx = 0;
818 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
819#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
820 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000821 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
822 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000823 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
824 ++Idx;
825#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
826#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000828 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
829
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000830 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000831 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
832 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
833 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
834 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
835 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
836 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000837 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000838 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
839 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
840 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
841 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
842 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
843 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000844 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
846 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
847 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
848 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
849 << NumImplicitDestructors
850 << " implicit destructors created\n";
851
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000852 if (ExternalSource.get()) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000853 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000854 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
855 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000856
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000857 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000858}
859
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000860TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
861 if (!Int128Decl) {
862 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Int128Ty);
863 Int128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
864 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
865 SourceLocation(),
866 SourceLocation(),
867 &Idents.get("__int128_t"),
868 TInfo);
869 }
870
871 return Int128Decl;
872}
873
874TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
875 if (!UInt128Decl) {
876 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnsignedInt128Ty);
877 UInt128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
878 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
879 SourceLocation(),
880 SourceLocation(),
881 &Idents.get("__uint128_t"),
882 TInfo);
883 }
884
885 return UInt128Decl;
886}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000887
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000888TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000889 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000890 if (!Float128StubDecl) {
Nico Weber95296d42013-06-20 23:30:30 +0000891 Float128StubDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
892 TTK_Struct,
893 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
894 SourceLocation(),
895 SourceLocation(),
896 &Idents.get("__float128"));
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000897 }
898
899 return Float128StubDecl;
900}
901
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000902void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000903 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000904 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000905 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000906}
907
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000908void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
909 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
910 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000911 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000912
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000913 this->Target = &Target;
914
915 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
916 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000917 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000918
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000919 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000920 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000921
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000922 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000923 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000924 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000925 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000926 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
927 else
928 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000929 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000930 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
931 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
932 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
933 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
934 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000935
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000936 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000937 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
938 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
939 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
940 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
941 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000942
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000943 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000944 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
945 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
946 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000947
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000948 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
949 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
950 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
951
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000952 // C++ 3.9.1p5
953 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
954 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
955 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
956 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
957 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
958 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
959 else {
960 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
961 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
962 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000963
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000964 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
965
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000966 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
967 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
968 else // C99
969 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
970
971 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
972 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
973 else // C99
974 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
975
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000976 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
977 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
978 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
979 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
980 // expressions.
981 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000982
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000983 // Placeholder type for functions.
984 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
985
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +0000986 // Placeholder type for bound members.
987 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
988
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +0000989 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
990 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
991
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +0000992 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
993 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
994
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +0000995 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
996 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
997
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +0000998 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
999 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1000
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001001 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001002 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1003 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1004 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001005
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001006 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001007 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1008 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001009 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001010
1011 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1012 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1013 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1014 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1015 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1016 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1017 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001018
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001019 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001020 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001021 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001022
1023 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001024 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1025 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001026
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001027 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001028
1029 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001030
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001031 // void * type
1032 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001033
1034 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1035 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001036
1037 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1038 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001039
1040 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1041 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001042}
1043
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001044DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001045 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1046}
1047
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001048AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1049 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1050 if (!Result) {
1051 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1052 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1053 }
1054
1055 return *Result;
1056}
1057
1058/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1059void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1060 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1061 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1062 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1063 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1064 }
1065}
1066
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001067// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001068MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001069ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001070 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001071 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1072 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1073}
1074
1075ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1076ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1077 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1078 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1079 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1080 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001081
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001082 return Pos->second;
1083}
1084
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001085void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001086ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001087 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1088 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001089 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1090 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001091 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1092 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1093}
1094
1095void
1096ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1097 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1098 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1099 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1100 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001101}
1102
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001103FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1104 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1105 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1106 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001107 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1108 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001109 return 0;
1110
1111 return Pos->second;
1112}
1113
1114void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1115 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1116 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1117 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001118 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001119}
1120
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001121NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001122ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001123 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001124 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1125 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001126 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001127
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001128 return Pos->second;
1129}
1130
1131void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001132ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1133 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1134 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1135 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1136 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1137 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1138 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1139}
1140
1141UsingShadowDecl *
1142ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1143 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1144 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1145 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1146 return 0;
1147
1148 return Pos->second;
1149}
1150
1151void
1152ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1153 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1154 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1155 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001156}
1157
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001158FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1159 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1160 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1161 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1162 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001163
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001164 return Pos->second;
1165}
1166
1167void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1168 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1169 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1170 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1171 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1172 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001173
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001174 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1175}
1176
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001177ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1178ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1179 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001180 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001181 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1182 return 0;
1183
1184 return Pos->second.begin();
1185}
1186
1187ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1188ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1189 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001190 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001191 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1192 return 0;
1193
1194 return Pos->second.end();
1195}
1196
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001197unsigned
1198ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1199 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001200 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001201 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1202 return 0;
1203
1204 return Pos->second.size();
1205}
1206
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001207void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1208 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001209 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001210 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1211}
1212
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001213void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1214 const NamedDecl *D,
1215 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001216 assert(D);
1217
1218 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001219 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1220 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001221 return;
1222 }
1223
1224 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1225 if (!Method)
1226 return;
1227
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001228 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1229 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001230 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001231}
1232
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001233void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1234 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1235 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1236 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1237 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1238 LastLocalImport = Import;
1239 return;
1240 }
1241
1242 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1243 LastLocalImport = Import;
1244}
1245
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001246//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1247// Type Sizing and Analysis
1248//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001249
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001250/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1251/// scalar floating point type.
1252const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001253 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001254 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1255 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001256 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001257 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001258 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1259 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1260 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001261 }
1262}
1263
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001264CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001265 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001266
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001267 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1268 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1269 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001270
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001271 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1272 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1273 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1274 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001275 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001276 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1277 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1278 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1279 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1280 } else {
1281 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1282 }
1283 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001284 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1285 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1286 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1287 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001288
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001289 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1290 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001291 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001292 // do nothing
1293
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001294 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001295 QualType T = VD->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001296 if (const ReferenceType* RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001297 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001298 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1299 else
1300 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1301 }
1302 if (!T->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001303 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1304 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001305 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001306 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1307 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001308 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1309 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1310 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1311 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1312 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1313 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001314
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001315 // Walk through any array types while we're at it.
1316 T = getBaseElementType(arrayType);
1317 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001318 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001319 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1320 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1321 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1322 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001323 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001324
1325 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1326 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1327 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1328 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1329 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001330 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1331 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1332 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1333 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1334 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001335
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001336 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1337 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001338
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001339 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1340 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1341 if (Offset > 0) {
1342 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1343 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1344 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1345 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1346 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1347 }
1348
1349 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001350 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001351 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001352 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001353
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001354 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001355}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001356
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001357// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1358// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1359// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1360// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1361std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1362ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1363 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1364
1365 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1366 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1367 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1368 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1369 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1370 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1371 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1372 }
1373 }
1374
1375 return sizeAndAlign;
1376}
1377
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001378/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1379/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1380std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1381static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1382 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1383 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1384 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1385 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001386 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1387 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001388 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1389 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1390 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001391 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1392 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1393 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001394 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1395 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1396}
1397
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001398std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001399ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001400 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1401 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001402 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001403 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1404 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001405}
1406
1407std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001408ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001409 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1410}
1411
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001412std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1413 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1414 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1415 return it->second;
1416
1417 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1418 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1419 return Info;
1420}
1421
1422/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1423/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001424///
1425/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1426/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1427/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001428std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001429ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5b9a3d52009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001430 uint64_t Width=0;
1431 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001432 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001433#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1434#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001435#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001436#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001437#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1438 case Type::Class: \
1439 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1440 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001441#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001442 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001443
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001444 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1445 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001446 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1447 Width = 0;
1448 Align = 32;
1449 break;
1450
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001451 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001452 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001453 Width = 0;
1454 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1455 break;
1456
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001457 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001458 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001459
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001460 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001461 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001462 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1463 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001464 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001465 Align = EltInfo.second;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001466 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1467 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1468 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001469 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001470 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001471 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001472 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001473 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1474 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1475 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001476 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001477 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1478 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001479 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001480 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1481 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1482 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001483 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1484 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1485 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1486 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001487 break;
1488 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001489
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001490 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001491 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001492 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001493 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001494 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1495 Width = 0;
1496 Align = 8;
1497 break;
1498
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001499 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001500 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1501 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001502 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001503 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1504 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1505 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001506 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001507 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1508 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001509 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001510 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1511 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001512 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1513 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001514 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001515 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001516 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1517 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001518 break;
1519 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001520 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1521 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001522 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001523 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001524 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001525 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1526 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001527 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001528 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001529 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001530 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1531 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001532 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001533 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001534 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001535 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1536 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001537 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001538 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001539 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001540 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1541 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001542 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001543 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1544 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1545 Width = 128;
1546 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1547 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001548 case BuiltinType::Half:
1549 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1550 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1551 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001552 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001553 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1554 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001555 break;
1556 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001557 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1558 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001559 break;
1560 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001561 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1562 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001563 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001564 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001565 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1566 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001567 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001568 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1569 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1570 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001571 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1572 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001573 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001574 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1575 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1576 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1577 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1578 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001579 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001580 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1581 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1582 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1583 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1584 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1585 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1586 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1587 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1588 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1589 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001590 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001591 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001592 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001593 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1594 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001595 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001596 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001597 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1598 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001599 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1600 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001601 break;
1602 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001603 case Type::LValueReference:
1604 case Type::RValueReference: {
1605 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1606 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001607 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1608 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001609 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1610 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001611 break;
1612 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001613 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001614 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001615 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1616 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001617 break;
1618 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001619 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001620 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Reid Kleckner3a52abf2013-03-28 20:02:56 +00001621 llvm::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001622 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001623 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001624 case Type::Complex: {
1625 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1626 // size.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001627 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001628 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001629 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001630 Align = EltInfo.second;
1631 break;
1632 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001633 case Type::ObjCObject:
1634 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001635 case Type::Decayed:
1636 return getTypeInfo(cast<DecayedType>(T)->getDecayedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001637 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001638 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001639 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001640 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001641 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001642 break;
1643 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001644 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001645 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001646 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1647
1648 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001649 Width = 8;
1650 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001651 break;
1652 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001653
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001654 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001655 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1656
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001657 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001658 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001659 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001660 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001661 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001662 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001663
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001664 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001665 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1666 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001667
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001668 case Type::Auto: {
1669 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001670 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1671 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001672 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001673 }
1674
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001675 case Type::Paren:
1676 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1677
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001678 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001679 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001680 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1681 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001682 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1683 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1684 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1685 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1686 Align = AttrAlign;
1687 else
1688 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001689 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001690 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001691 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001692
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001693 case Type::Elaborated:
1694 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001695
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001696 case Type::Attributed:
1697 return getTypeInfo(
1698 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1699
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001700 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001701 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001702 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1703 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1704 Width = Info.first;
1705 Align = Info.second;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001706
1707 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1708 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1709 // favorable to atomic operations:
1710 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1711 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1712 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1713 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1714
1715 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001716 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1717 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001718 }
1719
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001720 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001721
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001722 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001723 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001724}
1725
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001726/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1727CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1728 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1729}
1730
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001731/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1732int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1733 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1734}
1735
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001736/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1737/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001738CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001739 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001740}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001741CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001742 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001743}
1744
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001745/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001746/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001747CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001748 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001749}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001750CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001751 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001752}
1753
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001754/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1755/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1756/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1757/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001758unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001759 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001760
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001761 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1762 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1763
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001764 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001765 if (const ComplexType* CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001766 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1767 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001768 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1769 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001770 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1771
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001772 return ABIAlign;
1773}
1774
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001775/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1776/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1777unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1778 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1779}
1780
1781/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1782/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1783CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1784 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1785}
1786
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001787/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1788/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1789/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1790/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1791/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001792///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001793void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1794 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001795 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001796 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1797 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1798 if (!leafClass) {
1799 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::ivar_iterator I = OI->ivar_begin(),
1800 E = OI->ivar_end(); I != E; ++I)
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00001801 Ivars.push_back(*I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001802 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001803 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001804 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001805 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1806 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1807 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001808}
1809
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001810/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1811/// those inherited by it.
1812void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001813 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001814 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001815 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1816 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1817 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::all_protocol_iterator P = OI->all_referenced_protocol_begin(),
1818 PE = OI->all_referenced_protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001819 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001820 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001821 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001822 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001823 Protocols.insert((*P)->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001824 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1825 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001826 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001827
1828 // Categories of this Interface.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001829 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::visible_categories_iterator
1830 Cat = OI->visible_categories_begin(),
1831 CatEnd = OI->visible_categories_end();
1832 Cat != CatEnd; ++Cat) {
1833 CollectInheritedProtocols(*Cat, Protocols);
1834 }
1835
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001836 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1837 while (SD) {
1838 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1839 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1840 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001841 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001842 for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator P = OC->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001843 PE = OC->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1844 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001845 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001846 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1847 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1848 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1849 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001850 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001851 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = OP->protocol_begin(),
1852 PE = OP->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1853 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001854 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001855 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1856 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1857 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1858 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001859 }
1860}
1861
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001862unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001863 unsigned count = 0;
1864 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001865 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
1866 Ext = OI->known_extensions_begin(),
1867 ExtEnd = OI->known_extensions_end();
1868 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
1869 count += Ext->ivar_size();
1870 }
1871
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001872 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1873 // includes synthesized ivars.
1874 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001875 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1876
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001877 return count;
1878}
1879
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001880bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1881 if (!E)
1882 return false;
1883
1884 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1885 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1886
1887 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1888 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1889 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1890 return true;
1891
1892 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1893 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1894
1895 return false;
1896}
1897
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001898/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1899ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1900 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1901 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1902 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1903 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1904 return 0;
1905}
1906/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1907ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1908 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1909 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1910 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1911 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1912 return 0;
1913}
1914
1915/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1916void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1917 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1918 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1919 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1920}
1921/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1922void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1923 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1924 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1925 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1926}
1927
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001928const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1929 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1930 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1931 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001932 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001933 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1934 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001935 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001936 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1937 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001938 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1939
1940 return 0;
1941}
1942
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001943/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1944/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001945Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001946 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1947 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1948 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001949 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001950 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001951 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : 0;
1952}
1953
1954/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1955void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1956 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001957 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1958 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001959 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1960}
1961
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001962TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001963 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001964 if (!DataSize)
1965 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1966 else
1967 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001968 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001969
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001970 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1971 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1972 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1973 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001974}
1975
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001976TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001977 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001978 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001979 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001980 return DI;
1981}
1982
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001983const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001984ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001985 return getObjCLayout(D, 0);
1986}
1987
1988const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001989ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1990 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001991 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1992}
1993
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001994//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1995// Type creation/memoization methods
1996//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1997
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001998QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001999ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2000 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2001 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002002
2003 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2004 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002005 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2006 void *insertPos = 0;
2007 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2008 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2009 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002010 }
2011
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002012 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2013 QualType canon;
2014 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2015 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002016 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2017 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002018
2019 // Re-find the insert position.
2020 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2021 }
2022
2023 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2024 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2025 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002026}
2027
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002028QualType
2029ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002030 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2031 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002032 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002033
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002034 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2035 // into one ExtQuals node.
2036 QualifierCollector Quals;
2037 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002038
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002039 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2040 // another one.
2041 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2042 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2043 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002044
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002045 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002046}
2047
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002048QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002049 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002050 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002051 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002052 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002053
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002054 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2055 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002056 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002057 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2058 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2059 }
2060 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002061
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002062 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2063 // into one ExtQuals node.
2064 QualifierCollector Quals;
2065 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002067 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2068 // another one.
2069 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2070 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2071 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002072
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002073 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002074}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002075
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002076const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2077 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2078 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2079 return T;
2080
2081 QualType Result;
2082 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2083 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getResultType(), Info);
2084 } else {
2085 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2086 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2087 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00002088 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getResultType(), FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002089 }
2090
2091 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2092}
2093
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002094void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2095 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002096 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2097 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002098 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2099 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2100 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002101 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2102 FD = Next;
2103 else
2104 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002105 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002106 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2107 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002108}
2109
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002110/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2111/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002112QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002113 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2114 // structure.
2115 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2116 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002117
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002118 void *InsertPos = 0;
2119 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2120 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002121
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002122 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2123 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2124 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002125 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002126 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002128 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2129 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002130 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002131 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002132 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002133 Types.push_back(New);
2134 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2135 return QualType(New, 0);
2136}
2137
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002138/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2139/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002140QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002141 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2142 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002143 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002144 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002146 void *InsertPos = 0;
2147 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002148 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002150 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2151 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002152 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002153 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002154 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002156 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2157 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2158 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2159 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002160 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002161 Types.push_back(New);
2162 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002163 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002164}
2165
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002166QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2167 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2168
2169 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2170 DecayedType::Profile(ID, T);
2171 void *InsertPos = 0;
2172 if (DecayedType *DT = DecayedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2173 return QualType(DT, 0);
2174
2175 QualType Decayed;
2176
2177 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2178 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2179 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2180 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2181 // the array type derivation.
2182 if (T->isArrayType())
2183 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2184
2185 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2186 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2187 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2188 // in 6.3.2.1.
2189 if (T->isFunctionType())
2190 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2191
2192 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2193
2194 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2195 DecayedType *NewIP = DecayedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2196 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2197
2198 DecayedType *New =
2199 new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2200 Types.push_back(New);
2201 DecayedTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2202 return QualType(New, 0);
2203}
2204
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002206/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002207QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002208 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2209 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002210 // structure.
2211 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2212 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002213
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002214 void *InsertPos = 0;
2215 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2216 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2217 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218
2219 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002220 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2221 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002222 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002223 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002224
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002225 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2226 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2227 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002228 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002229 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002230 BlockPointerType *New
2231 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002232 Types.push_back(New);
2233 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2234 return QualType(New, 0);
2235}
2236
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002237/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2238/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002239QualType
2240ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002241 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2242 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2243
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002244 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2245 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002246 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002247 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002248
2249 void *InsertPos = 0;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002250 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2251 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002252 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002253
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002254 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2255
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002256 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2257 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2258 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002259 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2260 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2261 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002262
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002263 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002264 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2265 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002266 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002267 }
2268
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002269 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002270 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2271 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002272 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002273 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002274
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002275 return QualType(New, 0);
2276}
2277
2278/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2279/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002280QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002281 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2282 // structure.
2283 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002284 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002285
2286 void *InsertPos = 0;
2287 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2288 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2289 return QualType(RT, 0);
2290
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002291 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2292
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002293 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2294 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2295 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002296 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2297 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2298 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002299
2300 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2301 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2302 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002303 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002304 }
2305
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002306 RValueReferenceType *New
2307 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002308 Types.push_back(New);
2309 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002310 return QualType(New, 0);
2311}
2312
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002313/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2314/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002315QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002316 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2317 // structure.
2318 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2319 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2320
2321 void *InsertPos = 0;
2322 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2323 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2324 return QualType(PT, 0);
2325
2326 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2327 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2328 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002329 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002330 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2331
2332 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2333 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2334 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002335 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002336 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002337 MemberPointerType *New
2338 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002339 Types.push_back(New);
2340 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2341 return QualType(New, 0);
2342}
2343
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002344/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002345/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002346QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002347 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002348 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002349 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002350 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2351 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002352 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2353
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002354 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2355 // the target.
2356 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002357 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002358 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002359
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002360 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002361 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002362
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002363 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002364 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002365 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002366 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002367
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002368 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2369 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2370 QualType Canon;
2371 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2372 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002373 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002374 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002375 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002376
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002377 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002378 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002379 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002380 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002381 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002382
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002383 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002384 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002385 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002386 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002387 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002388}
2389
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002390/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2391/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2392/// sizes replaced with [*].
2393QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2394 // Vastly most common case.
2395 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002396
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002397 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002398
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002399 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002400 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002401 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2402#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2403#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2404#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2405#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2406 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2407
2408 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2409 case Type::Builtin:
2410 case Type::Complex:
2411 case Type::Vector:
2412 case Type::ExtVector:
2413 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2414 case Type::ObjCObject:
2415 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2416 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2417 case Type::Record:
2418 case Type::Enum:
2419 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2420 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2421 case Type::TypeOf:
2422 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002423 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002424 case Type::DependentName:
2425 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2426 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2427 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2428 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2429 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002430 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002431 case Type::PackExpansion:
2432 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2433
2434 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2435 // further decay.
2436 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2437 case Type::FunctionProto:
2438 case Type::BlockPointer:
2439 case Type::MemberPointer:
2440 return type;
2441
2442 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2443 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2444 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2445 // optimizations available here.
2446 case Type::Pointer:
2447 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2448 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2449 break;
2450
2451 case Type::LValueReference: {
2452 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2453 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2454 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2455 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2456 break;
2457 }
2458
2459 case Type::RValueReference: {
2460 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2461 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2462 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2463 break;
2464 }
2465
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002466 case Type::Atomic: {
2467 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2468 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2469 break;
2470 }
2471
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002472 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2473 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2474 result = getConstantArrayType(
2475 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2476 cat->getSize(),
2477 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2478 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2479 break;
2480 }
2481
2482 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2483 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2484 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2485 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2486 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2487 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2488 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2489 dat->getBracketsRange());
2490 break;
2491 }
2492
2493 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2494 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2495 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2496 result = getVariableArrayType(
2497 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2498 /*size*/ 0,
2499 ArrayType::Normal,
2500 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2501 SourceRange());
2502 break;
2503 }
2504
2505 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2506 case Type::VariableArray: {
2507 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2508 result = getVariableArrayType(
2509 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2510 /*size*/ 0,
2511 ArrayType::Star,
2512 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2513 vat->getBracketsRange());
2514 break;
2515 }
2516 }
2517
2518 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002519 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002520}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002521
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002522/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2523/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002524QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2525 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002526 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002527 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002528 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002529 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2530 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002531 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002532
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002533 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2534 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2535 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002536 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002537 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002538 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002539 }
2540
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002541 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002542 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002543
2544 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2545 Types.push_back(New);
2546 return QualType(New, 0);
2547}
2548
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002549/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2550/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002551/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002552QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2553 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002554 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002555 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2556 SourceRange brackets) const {
2557 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2558 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002559 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2560
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002561 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2562 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2563 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2564 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2565 if (!numElements) {
2566 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2567 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2568 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2569 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2570 brackets);
2571 Types.push_back(newType);
2572 return QualType(newType, 0);
2573 }
2574
2575 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2576 // also build a canonical type.
2577
2578 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2579
2580 void *insertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002581 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002582 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002583 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002584 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002585
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002586 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2587 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2588 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002589
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002590 // If we don't have one, build one.
2591 if (!canonTy) {
2592 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002593 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002594 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2595 brackets);
2596 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2597 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002598 }
2599
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002600 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2601 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002602 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002603
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002604 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2605 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002606 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002607 return canon;
2608
2609 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2610 // of the element type.
2611 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2612 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2613 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2614 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2615 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2616 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002617}
2618
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002619QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002620 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002621 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002622 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002623 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002624
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002625 void *insertPos = 0;
2626 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2627 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2628 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002629
2630 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002631 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2632 // qualifiers off the element type.
2633 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002634
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002635 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2636 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002637 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002638 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002639 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002640
2641 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002642 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2643 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2644 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002645 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002646
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002647 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2648 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002649
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002650 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2651 Types.push_back(newType);
2652 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002653}
2654
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002655/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2656/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002657QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002658 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002659 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002660
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002661 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2662 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002663 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002664
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002665 void *InsertPos = 0;
2666 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2667 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2668
2669 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2670 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2671 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002672 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002673 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002674
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002675 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2676 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002677 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002678 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002679 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002680 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002681 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2682 Types.push_back(New);
2683 return QualType(New, 0);
2684}
2685
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002686/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002687/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002688QualType
2689ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002690 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002691
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002692 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2693 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002694 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002695 VectorType::GenericVector);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002696 void *InsertPos = 0;
2697 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2698 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2699
2700 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2701 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2702 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002703 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002704 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002705
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002706 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2707 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002708 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002709 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002710 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2711 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002712 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2713 Types.push_back(New);
2714 return QualType(New, 0);
2715}
2716
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002717QualType
2718ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2719 Expr *SizeExpr,
2720 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002721 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002722 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002723 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002724
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002725 void *InsertPos = 0;
2726 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2727 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2728 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2729 if (Canon) {
2730 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2731 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002732 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2733 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2734 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002735 } else {
2736 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2737 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002738 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2739 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2740 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002741
2742 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2743 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2744 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2745 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002746 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2747 } else {
2748 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2749 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002750 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2751 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002752 }
2753 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002754
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002755 Types.push_back(New);
2756 return QualType(New, 0);
2757}
2758
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002759/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002760///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002761QualType
2762ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2763 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002764 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2765
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002766 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2767 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002768 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002769 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002770
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002771 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002772 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002773 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002774 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002775
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002776 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002777 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2778 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002779
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002780 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002781 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2782 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002783 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002784 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002785
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002786 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002787 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002788 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002789 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002790 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002791 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002792}
2793
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002794/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2795static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2796 return T.isCanonical() &&
2797 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2798 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2799}
2800
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002801/// getFunctionType - Return a normal function type with a typed argument
2802/// list. isVariadic indicates whether the argument list includes '...'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002803QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002804ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002805 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002806 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2807
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002808 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2809 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002810 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002811 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2812 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002813
2814 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002815 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002816 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002817 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002818
2819 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002820 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002821 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002822 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002823 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002824 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002825 isCanonical = false;
2826
2827 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002828 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002829 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002830 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002831 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002832 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2833 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002834 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002835
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002836 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002837 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002838 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2839 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002840
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002841 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2842 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2843 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2844 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2845 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2846 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2847 }
2848
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002849 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002850
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002851 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002852 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2853 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002854 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002855 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002856
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002857 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2858 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2859 // - parameter types
2860 // - exception types
2861 // - consumed-arguments flags
2862 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002863 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2864 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002865 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002866 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002867 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002868 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002869 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002870 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002871 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002872 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002873 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2874 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002875 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002876 if (EPI.ConsumedArguments)
2877 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2878
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002879 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002880 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002881 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002882 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002883 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002884 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002885}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002886
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002887#ifndef NDEBUG
2888static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2889 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2890 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2891 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2892 return true;
2893 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2894 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2895 return true;
2896 return false;
2897}
2898#endif
2899
2900/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2901/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2902QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002903 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002904 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2905 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2906 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002907 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002908 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2909 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2910 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2911 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002912 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002913 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002914 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2915 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002916 }
2917 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2918}
2919
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002920/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2921/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002922QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002923 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002924 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002925
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002926 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002927 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002928
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002929 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2930 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2931
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002932 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002933 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002934 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002935 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002936 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002937 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002938 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002939 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002940 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002941 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2942 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2943 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002944 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002945 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002946
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002947 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002948}
2949
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002950/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002951/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002952QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002953ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2954 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002955 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002956
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002957 if (Canonical.isNull())
2958 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002959 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002960 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002961 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2962 Types.push_back(newType);
2963 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002964}
2965
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002966QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002967 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2968
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002969 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002970 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2971 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2972
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002973 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2974 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2975 Types.push_back(newType);
2976 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002977}
2978
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002979QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002980 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2981
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002982 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002983 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2984 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2985
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002986 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
2987 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2988 Types.push_back(newType);
2989 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002990}
2991
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00002992QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
2993 QualType modifiedType,
2994 QualType equivalentType) {
2995 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
2996 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
2997
2998 void *insertPos = 0;
2999 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3000 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3001
3002 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3003 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3004 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3005
3006 Types.push_back(type);
3007 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3008
3009 return QualType(type, 0);
3010}
3011
3012
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003013/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3014QualType
3015ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003016 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003017 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003018 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3019
3020 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3021 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3022 void *InsertPos = 0;
3023 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3024 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3025
3026 if (!SubstParm) {
3027 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3028 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3029 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3030 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3031 }
3032
3033 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3034}
3035
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003036/// \brief Retrieve a
3037QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3038 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3039 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3040#ifndef NDEBUG
3041 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
3042 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
3043 P != PEnd; ++P) {
3044 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3045 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3046 }
3047#endif
3048
3049 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3050 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3051 void *InsertPos = 0;
3052 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3053 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3054 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3055
3056 QualType Canon;
3057 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3058 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3059 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3060 ArgPack);
3061 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3062 }
3063
3064 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3065 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3066 ArgPack);
3067 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3068 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3069 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3070}
3071
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003072/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003073/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003074/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003075QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003076 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003077 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003078 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003079 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003080 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003081 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003082 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3083
3084 if (TypeParm)
3085 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003086
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003087 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003088 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003089 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003090
3091 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3092 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3093 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3094 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003095 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003096 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3097 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003098
3099 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3100 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3101
3102 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3103}
3104
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003105TypeSourceInfo *
3106ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3107 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3108 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003109 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003110 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3111 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003112 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003113
3114 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003115 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3116 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003117 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003118 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3119 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3120 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3121 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3122 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3123 return DI;
3124}
3125
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003126QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003127ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003128 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003129 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003130 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3131 "No dependent template names here!");
3132
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003133 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3134
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003135 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003136 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3137 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3138 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3139
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003140 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003141 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003142}
3143
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003144#ifndef NDEBUG
3145static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3146 unsigned NumArgs) {
3147 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3148 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3149 return true;
3150
3151 return true;
3152}
3153#endif
3154
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003155QualType
3156ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003157 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3158 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003159 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003160 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3161 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003162 // Look through qualified template names.
3163 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3164 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003165
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003166 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003167 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3168 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003169 QualType CanonType;
3170 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3171 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3172 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003173 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3174 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3175 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3176 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3177 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003178 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3179 NumArgs);
3180 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003181
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003182 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3183 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3184 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003185 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3186 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003187 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003188 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003189 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003190 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3191 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003192
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003193 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003194 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003195}
3196
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003197QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003198ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3199 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003200 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003201 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3202 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003203
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003204 // Look through qualified template names.
3205 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3206 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003207
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003208 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3209 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003210 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003211 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3212 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3213 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3214
3215 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3216 // exists.
3217 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3218 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3219 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3220
3221 void *InsertPos = 0;
3222 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3223 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3224
3225 if (!Spec) {
3226 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3227 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3228 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3229 TypeAlignment);
3230 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3231 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003232 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003233 Types.push_back(Spec);
3234 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3235 }
3236
3237 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3238 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3239 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3240}
3241
3242QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003243ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3244 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003245 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003246 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003247 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003248
3249 void *InsertPos = 0;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003250 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003251 if (T)
3252 return QualType(T, 0);
3253
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003254 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3255 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3256 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003257 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3258 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003259 (void)CheckT;
3260 }
3261
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003262 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003263 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003264 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003265 return QualType(T, 0);
3266}
3267
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003268QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003269ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3271 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3272
3273 void *InsertPos = 0;
3274 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3275 if (T)
3276 return QualType(T, 0);
3277
3278 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3279 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3280 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3281 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3282 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3283 (void)CheckT;
3284 }
3285
3286 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3287 Types.push_back(T);
3288 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3289 return QualType(T, 0);
3290}
3291
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003292QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3293 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3294 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003295 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003296 assert(NNS->isDependent() && "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3297
3298 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3299 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003300 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3301 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3302 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3303
3304 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3305 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003306 }
3307
3308 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003309 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003310
3311 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003312 DependentNameType *T
3313 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003314 if (T)
3315 return QualType(T, 0);
3316
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003317 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003318 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003319 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003320 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003321}
3322
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003323QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003324ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3325 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003326 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003327 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003329 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003330 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003331 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3332 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3333 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3334 ArgCopy.size(),
3335 ArgCopy.data());
3336}
3337
3338QualType
3339ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3340 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3341 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3342 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3343 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003344 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003345 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3346 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003347
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003348 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003349 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3350 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003351
3352 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003353 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3354 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003355 if (T)
3356 return QualType(T, 0);
3357
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003358 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003359
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003360 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3361 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3362
3363 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003364 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003365 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3366 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3367 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3368 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003369 }
3370
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003371 QualType Canon;
3372 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3373 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3374 Name, NumArgs,
3375 CanonArgs.data());
3376
3377 // Find the insert position again.
3378 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3379 }
3380
3381 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3382 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3383 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003384 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003385 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003386 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003387 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003388 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003389}
3390
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003391QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003392 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003393 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003394 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003395
3396 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3397 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3398 void *InsertPos = 0;
3399 PackExpansionType *T
3400 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3401 if (T)
3402 return QualType(T, 0);
3403
3404 QualType Canon;
3405 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003406 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3407 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3408 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3409 // parameters.
3410 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3411 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003412
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003413 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3414 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3415 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3416 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003417 }
3418
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003419 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003420 Types.push_back(T);
3421 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3422 return QualType(T, 0);
3423}
3424
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003425/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3426/// alphabetically.
3427static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3428 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003429 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003430}
3431
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003432static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003433 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3434 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3435
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003436 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3437 return false;
3438
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003439 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003440 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3441 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003442 return false;
3443 return true;
3444}
3445
3446static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003447 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3448 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003449
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003450 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3451 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3452
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003453 // Canonicalize.
3454 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3455 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3456
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003457 // Remove duplicates.
3458 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3459 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3460}
3461
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003462QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3463 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003464 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003465 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3466 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3467 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3468 return BaseType;
3469
3470 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003471 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003472 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003473 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003474 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3475 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003476
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003477 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3478 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003479 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003480 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3481 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3482 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003483 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003484 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003485 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3486
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003487 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003488 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3489 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003490 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003491 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3492 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003493 }
3494
3495 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003496 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3497 }
3498
3499 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3500 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3501 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3502 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3503 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3504
3505 Types.push_back(T);
3506 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3507 return QualType(T, 0);
3508}
3509
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003510/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3511/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3512/// list.
3513bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3514 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3515 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3516 return false;
3517
3518 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3519 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3520 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3521 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
3522 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = *I;
3523 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3524 return false;
3525 }
3526 return true;
3527 }
3528 return false;
3529}
3530
3531/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3532/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3533/// of protocols.
3534bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3535 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3536 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3537 return false;
3538 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3539 if (!OPT)
3540 return false;
3541 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3542 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003543 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3544 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3545 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3546 return false;
3547
3548 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator PI =
3549 InheritedProtocols.begin(),
3550 E = InheritedProtocols.end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003551 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3552 bool Adopts = false;
3553 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3554 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
3555 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = *I;
3556 // return 'true' if '*PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
3557 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(*PI, Proto)))
3558 break;
3559 }
3560 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003561 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003562 }
3563 return true;
3564}
3565
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003566/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3567/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003568QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003569 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3570 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3571
3572 void *InsertPos = 0;
3573 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3574 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3575 return QualType(QT, 0);
3576
3577 // Find the canonical object type.
3578 QualType Canonical;
3579 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3580 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3581
3582 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003583 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3584 }
3585
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003586 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003587 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3588 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3589 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003591 Types.push_back(QType);
3592 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003593 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003594}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003595
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003596/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3597/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003598QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3599 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003600 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3601 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003602
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003603 if (PrevDecl) {
3604 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3605 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3606 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3607 }
3608
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003609 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3610 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3611 Decl = Def;
3612
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003613 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3614 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3615 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3616 Types.push_back(T);
3617 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003618}
3619
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003620/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3621/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003622/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003624/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003625QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003626 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003627 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3628 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3629 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003630
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003631 void *InsertPos = 0;
3632 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3633 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3634 if (Canon) {
3635 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3636 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003637 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003638 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003639 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003640 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003641 Canon
3642 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003643 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3644 toe = Canon;
3645 }
3646 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003647 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003648 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003649 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003650 Types.push_back(toe);
3651 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003652}
3653
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003654/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3655/// TypeOfType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3656/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003657/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003658/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003659QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003660 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003661 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003662 Types.push_back(tot);
3663 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003664}
3665
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003666
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003667/// getDecltypeType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3668/// DecltypeType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3669/// memory savings. Since decltype(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003670/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
David Blaikie876657b2011-11-06 22:28:03 +00003671/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003672QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003673 DecltypeType *dt;
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003674
3675 // C++0x [temp.type]p2:
3676 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3677 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3678 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3679 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003680 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3681 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003682
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003683 void *InsertPos = 0;
3684 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3685 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3686 if (Canon) {
3687 // We already have a "canonical" version of an equivalent, dependent
3688 // decltype type. Use that as our canonical type.
Richard Smithef8bf432012-08-13 20:08:14 +00003689 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003690 QualType((DecltypeType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003691 } else {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003692 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003693 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003694 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3695 dt = Canon;
3696 }
3697 } else {
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003698 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
3699 getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003700 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003701 Types.push_back(dt);
3702 return QualType(dt, 0);
3703}
3704
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003705/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3706/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3707QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3708 QualType UnderlyingType,
3709 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3710 const {
3711 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003712 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3713 Kind,
3714 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003715 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003716 Types.push_back(Ty);
3717 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3718}
3719
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003720/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3721/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3722/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3723QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003724 bool IsDependent) const {
3725 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003726 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003727
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003728 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003729 void *InsertPos = 0;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003730 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003731 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003732 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3733 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003734
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003735 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003736 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003737 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003738 Types.push_back(AT);
3739 if (InsertPos)
3740 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3741 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003742}
3743
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003744/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3745/// the given value type.
3746QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3747 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3748 // structure.
3749 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3750 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3751
3752 void *InsertPos = 0;
3753 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3754 return QualType(AT, 0);
3755
3756 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3757 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3758 QualType Canonical;
3759 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3760 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3761
3762 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3763 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3764 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3765 }
3766 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3767 Types.push_back(New);
3768 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3769 return QualType(New, 0);
3770}
3771
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003772/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3773QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3774 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003775 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3776 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003777 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003778 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003779 return AutoDeductTy;
3780}
3781
3782/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3783QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3784 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3785 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3786 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3787 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3788}
3789
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003790/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3791/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003792QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003793 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003794 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3795 // away const? mutable?
3796 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003797}
3798
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003799/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3800/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3801/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003802CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003803 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003804}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003805
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003806/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3807CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3808 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3809}
3810
3811/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3812CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3813 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3814}
3815
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003816/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3817/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3818QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3819 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3820 return WCharTy;
3821}
3822
3823/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3824/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3825QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3826 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3827 return UnsignedIntTy;
3828}
3829
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003830QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3831 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3832}
3833
3834QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3835 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3836}
3837
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003838/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003839/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3840QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003841 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003842}
3843
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003844/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3845/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3846QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3847 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3848}
3849
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003850//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3851// Type Operators
3852//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3853
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003854CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003855 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3856 // qualifiers.
3857 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003858 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003859 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003860 QualType Result;
3861 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3862 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3863 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3864 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3865 } else {
3866 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3867 }
3868
3869 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3870}
3871
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003872QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3873 Qualifiers &quals) {
3874 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3875
3876 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3877 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3878 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3879 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3880 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003881 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003882
3883 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003884 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003885 quals = splitType.Quals;
3886 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003887 }
3888
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003889 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3890 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3891 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3892
3893 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3894 // can just use the results in splitType.
3895 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3896 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003897 quals = splitType.Quals;
3898 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003899 }
3900
3901 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3902 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003903 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003904
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003905 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003906 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003907 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3908 }
3909
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003910 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003911 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003912 }
3913
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003914 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003915 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003916 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003917 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3918 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3919 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3920 }
3921
3922 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003923 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003924 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3925 SourceRange());
3926}
3927
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003928/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3929/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3930/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3931/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3932/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3933/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3934/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3935/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3936bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3937 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3938 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3939 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3940 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3941 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3942 return true;
3943 }
3944
3945 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3946 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3947 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3948 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3949 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3950 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3951 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3952 return true;
3953 }
3954
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003955 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003956 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3957 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3958 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3959 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3960 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3961 return true;
3962 }
3963 }
3964
3965 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3966
3967 return false;
3968}
3969
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003970DeclarationNameInfo
3971ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3972 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003973 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3974 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3975 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003976 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003977 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
3978 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003979
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003980 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
3981 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
3982 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
3983 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
3984 }
3985
3986 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
3987 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003988 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003989 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003990 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
3991 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003992 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003993 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
3994 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
3995 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
3996 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3997 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3998 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003999 }
4000 }
4001
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004002 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4003 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4004 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4005 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4006 NameLoc);
4007 }
4008
4009 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4010 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4011 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4012 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4013 NameLoc);
4014 }
4015 }
4016
4017 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004018}
4019
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004020TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004021 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4022 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4023 case TemplateName::Template: {
4024 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004025 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004026 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004027 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4028
4029 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004030 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004031 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004032
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004033 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4034 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004035
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004036 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4037 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4038 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4039 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4040 }
4041
4042 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4043 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4044 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4045 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4046 }
4047
4048 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4049 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4050 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4051 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4052 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4053 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4054 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4055 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4056 }
4057 }
4058
4059 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004060}
4061
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004062bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4063 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4064 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4065 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4066}
4067
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004068TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004069ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004070 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4071 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4072 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004073
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004074 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004075 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004076
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004077 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004078 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4079 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004080 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004081
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004082 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4083 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4084 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4085
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004086 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4087 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004088
4089 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4090 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4091 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004092 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004093
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004094 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004095 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004096
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004097 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004098 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004100 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004101 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4102 return Arg;
4103
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004104 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4105 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004106 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004107 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004108 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4109 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4110 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004111
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004112 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004113 }
4114 }
4115
4116 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004117 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004118}
4119
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004120NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004121ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004122 if (!NNS)
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004123 return 0;
4124
4125 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4126 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4127 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004128 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004129 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4130 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4131
4132 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4133 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4134 // this namespace and no prefix.
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004135 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4136 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4137
4138 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4139 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4140 // this namespace and no prefix.
4141 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4142 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4143 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004144
4145 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4146 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4147 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004148
4149 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4150 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4151 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4152 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4153 // types, e.g.,
4154 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4155 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004156 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4157 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004158 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004159
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004160 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4161 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4162 // first place?
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004163 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0, false,
4164 const_cast<Type*>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004165 }
4166
4167 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4168 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4169 return NNS;
4170 }
4171
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004172 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004173}
4174
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004175
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004176const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004177 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004178 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004179 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4180 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4181 return AT;
4182 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004183
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004184 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004185 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004186 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004187
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004188 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004189 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4190 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004191
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004192 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4193 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004194 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004195
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004196 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004197 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004198
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004199 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004200 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004201 if (ATy == 0 || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004202 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004203
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004204 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4205 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004206 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004207
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004208 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4209 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4210 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004211 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004212 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4213 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4214 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004215 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004216
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004217 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004218 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4219 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004221 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004222 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004223 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004224 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004225
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004226 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004227 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004228 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004229 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004230 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004231 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004232}
4233
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004234QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004235 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4236 return getDecayedType(T);
4237 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004238}
4239
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004240QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004241 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4242 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4243 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4244}
4245
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004246/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4247/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4248/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4249/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4250///
4251/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004252QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004253 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4254 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4255 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4256 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4257 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4258 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004259
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004260 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004261
4262 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004263 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004264}
4265
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004266QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4267 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004268}
4269
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004270QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4271 Qualifiers qs;
4272 while (true) {
4273 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004274 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004275 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004276
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004277 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004278 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004279 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004280
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004281 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004282}
4283
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004284/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004285uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004286ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4287 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4288 do {
4289 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004290 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4291 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004292 } while (CA);
4293 return ElementCount;
4294}
4295
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004296/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4297/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004298static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004299 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004300 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004301
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004302 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4303 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004304 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004305 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004306 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4307 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4308 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004309 }
4310}
4311
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004312/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4313/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004314/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4315/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004316QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4317 QualType Domain) const {
4318 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4319 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4320 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004321 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004322 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4323 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4324 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4325 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004326 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004327
4328 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4329 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004330 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004331 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4332 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4333 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004334 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004335 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004336}
4337
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004338/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4339/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4340/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004341/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004342int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004343 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4344 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004346 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004347 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004348 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004349 return 1;
4350 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004351}
4352
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004353/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4354/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4355/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004356unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004357 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004358
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004359 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004360 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004361 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004362 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004363 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4364 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4365 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4366 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004367 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004368 case BuiltinType::Short:
4369 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004370 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004371 case BuiltinType::Int:
4372 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004373 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004374 case BuiltinType::Long:
4375 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004376 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004377 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4378 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004379 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004380 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4381 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4382 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004383 }
4384}
4385
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004386/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4387/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4388///
4389/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4390/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004391QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004392 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4393 return QualType();
4394
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004395 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004396 if (!Field)
4397 return QualType();
4398
4399 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4400
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004401 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004402 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4403 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4404 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4405 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4406 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4407 return IntTy;
4408
4409 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4410 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4411
4412 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4413 // like the base type.
4414 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4415 // is ridiculous.
4416 return QualType();
4417}
4418
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004419/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4420/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4421/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004422QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004423 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4424 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004425 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4426 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004427
4428 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4429 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4430 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4431 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4432 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4433 // unsigned long long int [...]
4434 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4435 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4436 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4437 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4438 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4439 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4440 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4441 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4442 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4443 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4444 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4445 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4446 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4447 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4448 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4449 }
4450 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4451 }
4452 }
4453
4454 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004455 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4456 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004457 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4458 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004459 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4460 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4461}
4462
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004463/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4464/// type and returns its ownership.
4465Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4466 while (!T.isNull()) {
4467 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4468 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4469 if (T->isArrayType())
4470 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4471 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4472 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4473 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004474 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004475 else
4476 break;
4477 }
4478
4479 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4480}
4481
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004482static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4483 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4484 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4485 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4486 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
4487 return NULL;
4488}
4489
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004490/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004491/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004492/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004493int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004494 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4495 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004496
4497 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4498 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4499 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4500 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4501 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4502
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004503 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004504
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004505 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4506 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004507
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004508 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4509 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004510
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004511 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4512 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4513 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4514 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004515
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004516 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4517 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4518 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4519 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4520 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004521
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004522 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4523 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004524 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004525 return -1;
4526 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004527
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004528 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4529 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4530 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004531
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004532 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4533 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004534 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004535 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004536}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004537
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004538static RecordDecl *
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004539CreateRecordDecl(const ASTContext &Ctx, RecordDecl::TagKind TK,
4540 DeclContext *DC, IdentifierInfo *Id) {
4541 SourceLocation Loc;
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004542 if (Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004543 return CXXRecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004544 else
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004545 return RecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004546}
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004547
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004548// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004549QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004550 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004551 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004552 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004553 &Idents.get("NSConstantString"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004554 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004555
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004556 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004557
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004558 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004559 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004560 // int flags;
4561 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004562 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004563 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004564 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004565 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4566
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004567 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004568 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004569 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004570 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004571 SourceLocation(), 0,
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004572 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004573 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004574 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004575 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004576 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004577 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004578 }
4579
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004580 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004581 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004582
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004583 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004584}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004585
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004586QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4587 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4588 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl =
4589 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl, &Idents.get("objc_super"));
4590 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4591 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4592 }
4593 return ObjCSuperType;
4594}
4595
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004596void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004597 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004598 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4599 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4600}
4601
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004602QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004603 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4604 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4605
4606 RecordDecl *T;
4607 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004608 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004609 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004610 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004611
4612 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4613 UnsignedLongTy,
4614 UnsignedLongTy,
4615 };
4616
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004617 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004618 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004619 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004620 };
4621
4622 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004623 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004624 SourceLocation(),
4625 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004626 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004627 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004628 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004629 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004630 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004631 T->addDecl(Field);
4632 }
4633
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004634 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004635
4636 BlockDescriptorType = T;
4637
4638 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4639}
4640
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004641QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004642 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4643 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4644
4645 RecordDecl *T;
4646 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004647 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004648 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004649 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004650
4651 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4652 UnsignedLongTy,
4653 UnsignedLongTy,
4654 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4655 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4656 };
4657
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004658 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004659 "reserved",
4660 "Size",
4661 "CopyFuncPtr",
4662 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4663 };
4664
4665 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004666 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004667 SourceLocation(),
4668 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004669 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004670 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004671 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004672 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004673 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004674 T->addDecl(Field);
4675 }
4676
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004677 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004678
4679 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = T;
4680
4681 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4682}
4683
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004684/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4685/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4686/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4687bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4688 const VarDecl *D) {
4689 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4690 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4691 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4692
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004693 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004694 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004695
4696 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4697
4698 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4699
4700 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4701 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4702 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4703
4704 switch (lifetime) {
4705 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4706
4707 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4708 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4709 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4710 return false;
4711
4712 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4713 // byref routines.
4714 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4715 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4716 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4717 return true;
4718 }
4719 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4720 }
4721 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4722 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004723}
4724
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004725bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4726 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4727 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4728
4729 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4730 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4731 return false;
4732
4733 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004734 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004735 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4736 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4737 }
4738 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4739 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4740 // MRR.
4741 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4742 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4743 else
4744 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4745 return true;
4746}
4747
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004748TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4749 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4750 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(*this,
4751 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
4752 SourceLocation(),
4753 SourceLocation(),
4754 &Idents.get("instancetype"),
4755 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(getObjCIdType()));
4756 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4757}
4758
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004759// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4760// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004761static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004762 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004763 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4764 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004765
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004766 return false;
4767}
4768
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004769/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004770/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004771CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004772 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4773 return CharUnits::Zero();
4774
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004775 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004776
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004777 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004778 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004779 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004780 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4781 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004782 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004783 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004784}
4785
4786static inline
4787std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4788 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004789}
4790
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004791/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004792/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004793std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4794 std::string S;
4795
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004796 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4797 QualType BlockTy =
4798 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4799 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004800 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004801 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None,
4802 BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4803 S, true /*Extended*/);
4804 else
4805 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4806 S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004807 // Compute size of all parameters.
4808 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4809 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4810 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004811 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4812 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Fariborz Jahanian590c3522010-04-08 18:06:22 +00004813 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004814 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4815 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004816 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004817 if (sz.isZero())
4818 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004819 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004820 ParmOffset += sz;
4821 }
4822 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004823 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004824 // Block pointer and offset.
4825 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004826
4827 // Argument types.
4828 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
4829 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), E =
4830 Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4831 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4832 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4833 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4834 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4835 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4836 // elements.
4837 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4838 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4839 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4840 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004841 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004842 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4843 S, true /*Extended*/);
4844 else
4845 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004846 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004847 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004848 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004849
4850 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004851}
4852
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004853bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004854 std::string& S) {
4855 // Encode result type.
4856 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getResultType(), S);
4857 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4858 // Compute size of all parameters.
4859 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4860 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4861 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
4862 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004863 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004864 continue;
4865
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004866 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004867 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004868 ParmOffset += sz;
4869 }
4870 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4871 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4872
4873 // Argument types.
4874 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4875 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4876 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4877 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4878 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4879 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4880 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4881 // elements.
4882 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4883 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4884 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4885 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4886 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4887 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4888 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4889 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004890
4891 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004892}
4893
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004894/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4895/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4896/// block object types.
4897void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4898 QualType T, std::string& S,
4899 bool Extended) const {
4900 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4901 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4902 // Encode parameter type.
4903 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, 0,
4904 true /*OutermostType*/,
4905 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4906 false /*StructField*/,
4907 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4908 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4909}
4910
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004911/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004912/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004913bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004914 std::string& S,
4915 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004916 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004917 // Encode return type.
4918 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4919 Decl->getResultType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004920 // Compute size of all parameters.
4921 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4922 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4923 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004924 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004925 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4926 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004927 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004928 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004929 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004930 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004931 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004932 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004933 continue;
4934
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004935 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4936 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004937 ParmOffset += sz;
4938 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004939 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004940 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004941 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004943 // Argument types.
4944 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004945 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004946 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004947 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004948 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004949 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004950 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4951 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4952 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004953 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004954 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4955 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4956 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004957 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4958 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004959 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004960 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004961 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004962
4963 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004964}
4965
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004966/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004967/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004968/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4969/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004970/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4971/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4972/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4973/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4974/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004975/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4976/// @code
4977/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4978/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4979/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4980/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4981/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4982/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4983/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4984/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00004985/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004986/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
4987/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
4988/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
4989/// };
4990/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004991void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004992 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004993 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004994 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
4995 bool Dynamic = false;
4996 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = 0;
4997
4998 // FIXME: Duplicated code due to poor abstraction.
4999 if (Container) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005000 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005001 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
5002 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005003 i = CID->propimpl_begin(), e = CID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor29bd76f2009-04-23 01:02:12 +00005004 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005005 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005006 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
5007 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
5008 Dynamic = true;
5009 } else {
5010 SynthesizePID = PID;
5011 }
5012 }
5013 }
5014 } else {
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00005015 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005016 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005017 i = OID->propimpl_begin(), e = OID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor29bd76f2009-04-23 01:02:12 +00005018 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005019 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005020 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
5021 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
5022 Dynamic = true;
5023 } else {
5024 SynthesizePID = PID;
5025 }
5026 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005027 }
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005028 }
5029 }
5030
5031 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5032 S = "T";
5033
5034 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005035 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5036 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005037 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PD->getType(), S, true, true, 0,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005038 true /* outermost type */,
5039 true /* encoding for property */);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005040
5041 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5042 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005043 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5044 S += ",C";
5045 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5046 S += ",&";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005047 } else {
5048 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5049 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5050 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005051 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005052 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005053 }
5054 }
5055
5056 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5057 // are "dynamic by default".
5058 if (Dynamic)
5059 S += ",D";
5060
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005061 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5062 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005063
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005064 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5065 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005066 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005067 }
5068
5069 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5070 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005071 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005072 }
5073
5074 if (SynthesizePID) {
5075 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5076 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005077 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005078 }
5079
5080 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5081}
5082
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005083/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005084/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5085/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005086/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5087///
5088void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005089 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005090 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005091 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005092 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005093 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005094 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005095 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5096 }
5097 }
5098}
5099
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005100void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005101 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005102 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5103 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5104 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5105 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005107 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005108}
5109
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005110static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5111 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5112 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005113 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5114 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5115 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5116 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005117 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005118 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005119 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005120 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5121 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005122 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005123 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5124 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5125 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5126 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5127 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005128 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5129 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005130 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5131 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005132 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005133 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5134 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5135 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5136 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005137 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005138 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5139
5140 case BuiltinType::Half:
5141 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5142 return ' ';
5143
5144 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5145 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5146 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5147 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5148
5149 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5150 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5151 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5152 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5153 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5154 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5155 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005156 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005157 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005158 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5159#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5160#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5161 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5162#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5163 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005164 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005165 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005166}
5167
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005168static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5169 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5170
5171 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5172 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5173 return 'i';
5174
5175 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005176 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5177 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005178}
5179
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005180static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005181 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005182 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005183 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005184 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5185 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5186 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5187 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5188 //
5189 // struct
5190 // {
5191 // int integer;
5192 // int flags:2;
5193 // };
5194 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5195 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5196 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5197 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5198 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005199 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005200 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5201 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005202 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005203 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5204 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005205 else {
5206 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5207 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5208 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005209 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005210 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005211}
5212
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005213// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005214void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5215 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5216 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005217 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005218 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005219 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005220 bool StructField,
5221 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005222 bool EncodeClassNames,
5223 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005224 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5225 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5226 case Type::Builtin:
5227 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005228 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005229 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005230 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5231 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5232 else
5233 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005234 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005235
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005236 case Type::Complex: {
5237 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005238 S += 'j';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005239 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, 0, false,
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005240 false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005241 return;
5242 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005243
5244 case Type::Atomic: {
5245 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5246 S += 'A';
5247 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, 0,
5248 false, false);
5249 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005250 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005251
5252 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5253 case Type::Pointer:
5254 case Type::LValueReference:
5255 case Type::RValueReference: {
5256 QualType PointeeTy;
5257 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5258 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5259 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5260 S += ':';
5261 return;
5262 }
5263 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5264 } else {
5265 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5266 }
5267
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005268 bool isReadOnly = false;
5269 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5270 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5271 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005272 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005273 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005274 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5275 isReadOnly = true;
5276 S += 'r';
5277 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005278 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005279 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005280 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5281 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005282 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5283 isReadOnly = true;
5284 S += 'r';
5285 }
5286 }
5287 if (isReadOnly) {
5288 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5289 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5290 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005291 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005292 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005293 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005294
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005295 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5296 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5297 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005298 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005299 S += '*';
5300 return;
5301 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005302 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005303 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5304 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5305 S += '#';
5306 return;
5307 }
5308 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5309 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5310 S += '@';
5311 return;
5312 }
5313 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005314 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005315 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005316 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5317
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005318 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005319 NULL);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005320 return;
5321 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005322
5323 case Type::ConstantArray:
5324 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5325 case Type::VariableArray: {
5326 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5327
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005328 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005329 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5330 S += '^';
5331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005332 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005333 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5334 } else {
5335 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005336
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005337 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5338 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5339 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005340 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005341 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5342 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005343 S += '0';
5344 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005345
5346 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005347 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5348 S += ']';
5349 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005350 return;
5351 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005352
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005353 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5354 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005355 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005356 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005357
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005358 case Type::Record: {
5359 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005360 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005361 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5362 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5363 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005364 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5365 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5366 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005367 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5368 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005369 TemplateArgs.data(),
5370 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005371 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005372 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005373 } else {
5374 S += '?';
5375 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005376 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005377 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005378 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5379 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5380 } else {
5381 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5382 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5383 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
5384 if (FD) {
5385 S += '"';
5386 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5387 S += '"';
5388 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005389
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005390 // Special case bit-fields.
5391 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5392 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005393 *Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005394 } else {
5395 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5396 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5397 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5398 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5399 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5400 /*StructField*/true);
5401 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005402 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005403 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005404 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005405 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005406 return;
5407 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005408
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005409 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5410 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005411 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005412 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005413 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005414
5415 S += '<';
5416 // Block return type
5417 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(FT->getResultType(), S,
5418 ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5419 FD,
5420 false /* OutermostType */,
5421 EncodingProperty,
5422 false /* StructField */,
5423 EncodeBlockParameters,
5424 EncodeClassNames);
5425 // Block self
5426 S += "@?";
5427 // Block parameters
5428 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5429 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator I = FPT->arg_type_begin(),
5430 E = FPT->arg_type_end(); I && (I != E); ++I) {
5431 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(*I, S,
5432 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5433 ExpandStructures,
5434 FD,
5435 false /* OutermostType */,
5436 EncodingProperty,
5437 false /* StructField */,
5438 EncodeBlockParameters,
5439 EncodeClassNames);
5440 }
5441 }
5442 S += '>';
5443 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005444 return;
5445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005446
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005447 case Type::ObjCObject:
5448 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5449 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5450 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005451
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005452 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5453 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5454 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005455 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005456 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005457 S += '{';
5458 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5459 S += II->getName();
5460 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005461 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005462 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5463 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005464 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005465 if (Field->isBitField())
5466 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005467 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005468 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5469 false, false, false, false, false,
5470 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005471 }
5472 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005473 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005474 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005475
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005476 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5477 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005478 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5479 S += '@';
5480 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005482
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005483 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5484 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5485 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5486 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005487 S += '#';
5488 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005490
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005491 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005492 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005493 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5494 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005495 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005496 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5497 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005498 S += '"';
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005499 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5500 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005501 S += '<';
5502 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5503 S += '>';
5504 }
5505 S += '"';
5506 }
5507 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005509
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005510 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5511 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005512 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5513 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005514 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005515 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005516 // {...};
5517 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005518 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005519 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005520 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5521 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5522 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5523 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5524 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5525 S += '{';
5526 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5527 S += '}';
5528 return;
5529 }
5530 }
5531 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005532 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5533 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005534 NULL,
5535 false, false, false, false, false,
5536 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005537 return;
5538 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005539
5540 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005541 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5542 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005543 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005544 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005545 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5546 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005547 S += '<';
5548 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5549 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005550 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005551 S += '"';
5552 }
5553 return;
5554 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005555
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005556 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005557 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5558 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005559 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005560
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005561 case Type::Vector:
5562 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005563 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5564 // insufficient.
5565 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5566 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005567
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005568 case Type::Auto:
5569 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5570 // Just ignore it.
5571 return;
5572
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005573#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5574#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5575#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5576 case Type::KIND:
5577#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5578 case Type::KIND:
5579#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5580 case Type::KIND:
5581#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5582 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005583 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005584 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005585}
5586
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005587void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5588 std::string &S,
5589 const FieldDecl *FD,
5590 bool includeVBases) const {
5591 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5592 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5593 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5594 return;
5595
5596 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5597 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5598 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5599
5600 if (CXXRec) {
5601 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5602 BI = CXXRec->bases_begin(),
5603 BE = CXXRec->bases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5604 if (!BI->isVirtual()) {
5605 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005606 if (base->isEmpty())
5607 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005608 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005609 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5610 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5611 }
5612 }
5613 }
5614
5615 unsigned i = 0;
5616 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5617 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5618 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5619 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5620 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005621 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005622 }
5623
5624 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5625 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5626 BI = CXXRec->vbases_begin(),
5627 BE = CXXRec->vbases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5628 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005629 if (base->isEmpty())
5630 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005631 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005632 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5633 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005634 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5635 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005636 }
5637 }
5638
5639 CharUnits size;
5640 if (CXXRec) {
5641 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5642 } else {
5643 size = layout.getSize();
5644 }
5645
5646 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5647 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5648 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5649
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005650 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5651 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005652 if (FD) {
5653 S += "\"_vptr$";
5654 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5655 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5656 S += recname;
5657 S += '"';
5658 }
5659 S += "^^?";
5660 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5661 }
5662
5663 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5664 // Mark the end of the structure.
5665 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5666 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5667 std::make_pair(offs, (NamedDecl*)0));
5668 }
5669
5670 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5671 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5672
5673 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5674 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5675 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5676 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5677 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5678 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5679 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5680 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5681 // longer then though.
5682 CurOffs += padding;
5683 }
5684
5685 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5686 if (dcl == 0)
5687 break; // reached end of structure.
5688
5689 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5690 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5691 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5692 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5693 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5694 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005695 assert(!base->isEmpty());
5696 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005697 } else {
5698 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5699 if (FD) {
5700 S += '"';
5701 S += field->getNameAsString();
5702 S += '"';
5703 }
5704
5705 if (field->isBitField()) {
5706 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005707 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005708 } else {
5709 QualType qt = field->getType();
5710 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5711 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5712 /*OutermostType*/false,
5713 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5714 /*StructField*/true);
5715 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5716 }
5717 }
5718 }
5719}
5720
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005721void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005722 std::string& S) const {
5723 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5724 S += 'n';
5725 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5726 S += 'N';
5727 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5728 S += 'o';
5729 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5730 S += 'O';
5731 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5732 S += 'R';
5733 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5734 S += 'V';
5735}
5736
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005737TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5738 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5739 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, 0, 0);
5740 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5741 TypeSourceInfo *IdInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5742 ObjCIdDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5743 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5744 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5745 &Idents.get("id"), IdInfo);
5746 }
5747
5748 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005749}
5750
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005751TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5752 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
5753 QualType SelT = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5754 TypeSourceInfo *SelInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SelT);
5755 ObjCSelDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5756 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5757 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5758 &Idents.get("SEL"), SelInfo);
5759 }
5760 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005761}
5762
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005763TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5764 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5765 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, 0, 0);
5766 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5767 TypeSourceInfo *ClassInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5768 ObjCClassDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5769 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5770 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5771 &Idents.get("Class"), ClassInfo);
5772 }
5773
5774 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005775}
5776
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005777ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5778 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5779 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5780 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5781 SourceLocation(),
5782 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5783 /*PrevDecl=*/0,
5784 SourceLocation(), true);
5785 }
5786
5787 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5788}
5789
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005790//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5791// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5792//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5793
5794static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5795 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
5796 QualType CharPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5797 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5798 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharPtrType);
5799
5800 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5801 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5802 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5803 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5804 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5805 TInfo);
5806 return VaListTypeDecl;
5807}
5808
5809static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5810 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
5811 QualType VoidPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5812 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5813 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VoidPtrType);
5814
5815 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5816 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5817 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5818 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5819 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5820 TInfo);
5821 return VaListTypeDecl;
5822}
5823
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005824static TypedefDecl *
5825CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5826 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5827 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5828 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5829 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5830 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5831 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5832 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5833 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5834 /*PrevDecl*/0);
5835
5836 VaListTagDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5837 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5838 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5839 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5840 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
5841 } else {
5842 // struct __va_list
5843 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5844 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5845 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5846 }
5847
5848 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5849
5850 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5851 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5852 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5853
5854 // void *__stack;
5855 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5856 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5857
5858 // void *__gr_top;
5859 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5860 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5861
5862 // void *__vr_top;
5863 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5864 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5865
5866 // int __gr_offs;
5867 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5868 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5869
5870 // int __vr_offs;
5871 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5872 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5873
5874 // Create fields
5875 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5876 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5877 VaListTagDecl,
5878 SourceLocation(),
5879 SourceLocation(),
5880 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5881 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5882 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5883 /*Mutable=*/false,
5884 ICIS_NoInit);
5885 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5886 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5887 }
5888 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5889 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5890 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5891
5892 // } __builtin_va_list;
5893 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5894 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5895 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5896 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5897 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5898 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5899
5900 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5901}
5902
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005903static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5904 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5905 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5906
5907 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5908 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5909 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5910 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5911
5912 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5913 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5914 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5915
5916 // unsigned char gpr;
5917 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5918 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5919
5920 // unsigned char fpr;
5921 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5922 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5923
5924 // unsigned short reserved;
5925 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5926 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5927
5928 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5929 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5930 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5931
5932 // void* reg_save_area;
5933 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5934 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5935
5936 // Create fields
5937 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5938 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5939 SourceLocation(),
5940 SourceLocation(),
5941 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5942 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5943 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5944 /*Mutable=*/false,
5945 ICIS_NoInit);
5946 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5947 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5948 }
5949 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5950 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005951 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005952
5953 // } __va_list_tag;
5954 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
5955 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5956 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5957 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5958 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
5959 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5960 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5961 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5962
5963 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5964 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5965 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5966 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5967 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
5968 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5969 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
5970 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5971 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5972 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5973 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5974 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5975 TInfo);
5976
5977 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5978}
5979
5980static TypedefDecl *
5981CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5982 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5983 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5984 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5985 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5986 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5987 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5988
5989 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5990 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5991 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5992
5993 // unsigned gp_offset;
5994 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5995 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5996
5997 // unsigned fp_offset;
5998 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5999 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6000
6001 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6002 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6003 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6004
6005 // void* reg_save_area;
6006 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6007 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6008
6009 // Create fields
6010 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6011 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6012 VaListTagDecl,
6013 SourceLocation(),
6014 SourceLocation(),
6015 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6016 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
6017 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6018 /*Mutable=*/false,
6019 ICIS_NoInit);
6020 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6021 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6022 }
6023 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6024 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006025 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006026
6027 // } __va_list_tag;
6028 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
6029 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6030 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6031 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6032 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
6033 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
6034 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6035 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6036
6037 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6038 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6039 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6040 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6041 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6042 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6043 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
6044 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
6045 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6046 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6047 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6048 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6049 TInfo);
6050
6051 return VaListTypedefDecl;
6052}
6053
6054static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6055 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6056 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6057 QualType IntArrayType
6058 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6059 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6060 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
6061 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6062 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6063 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6064 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6065 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(IntArrayType));
6066
6067 return VaListTypedefDecl;
6068}
6069
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006070static TypedefDecl *
6071CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6072 RecordDecl *VaListDecl;
6073 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6074 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6075 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6076 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6077 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6078 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6079 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6080 /*PrevDecl*/0);
6081
6082 VaListDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6083 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6084 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6085 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
6086
6087 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6088
6089 } else {
6090 // struct __va_list {
6091 VaListDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6092 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6093 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
6094 }
6095
6096 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6097
6098 // void * __ap;
6099 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6100 VaListDecl,
6101 SourceLocation(),
6102 SourceLocation(),
6103 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6104 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6105 /*TInfo=*/0,
6106 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6107 /*Mutable=*/false,
6108 ICIS_NoInit);
6109 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6110 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6111
6112 // };
6113 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6114
6115 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
6116 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6117 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl));
6118
6119 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
6120 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6121 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6122 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6123 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6124 TInfo);
6125
6126 return VaListTypeDecl;
6127}
6128
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006129static TypedefDecl *
6130CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6131 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6132 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6133 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6134 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6135 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
6136 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6137
6138 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6139 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6140 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6141
6142 // long __gpr;
6143 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6144 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6145
6146 // long __fpr;
6147 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6148 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6149
6150 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6151 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6152 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6153
6154 // void *__reg_save_area;
6155 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6156 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6157
6158 // Create fields
6159 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6160 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6161 VaListTagDecl,
6162 SourceLocation(),
6163 SourceLocation(),
6164 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6165 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
6166 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6167 /*Mutable=*/false,
6168 ICIS_NoInit);
6169 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6170 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6171 }
6172 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6173 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6174 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6175
6176 // } __va_list_tag;
6177 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
6178 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6179 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6180 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6181 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
6182 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
6183 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6184 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6185
6186 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6187 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6188 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6189 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6190 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6191 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6192 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
6193 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
6194 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6195 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6196 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6197 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6198 TInfo);
6199
6200 return VaListTypedefDecl;
6201}
6202
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006203static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6204 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6205 switch (Kind) {
6206 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6207 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6208 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6209 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006210 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6211 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006212 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6213 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6214 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6215 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6216 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6217 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006218 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6219 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006220 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6221 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006222 }
6223
6224 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6225}
6226
6227TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6228 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl)
6229 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6230
6231 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6232}
6233
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006234QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6235 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6236 // declaration.
6237 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6238 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6239
6240 return VaListTagTy;
6241}
6242
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006243void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006244 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006245 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006246
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006247 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006248}
6249
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006250/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6251/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006252TemplateName
6253ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6254 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006255 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6256 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6257
6258 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6259 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6260 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6261
6262 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006263 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006264 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6265 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6266 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6267 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6268 *Storage++ = D;
6269 }
6270
6271 return TemplateName(OT);
6272}
6273
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006274/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6275/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006276TemplateName
6277ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6278 bool TemplateKeyword,
6279 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006280 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6281
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006282 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006283 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6284 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6285
6286 void *InsertPos = 0;
6287 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6288 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6289 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006290 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6291 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006292 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6293 }
6294
6295 return TemplateName(QTN);
6296}
6297
6298/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6299/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006300TemplateName
6301ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6302 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006303 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006304 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006305
6306 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6307 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6308
6309 void *InsertPos = 0;
6310 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6311 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6312
6313 if (QTN)
6314 return TemplateName(QTN);
6315
6316 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6317 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006318 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6319 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006320 } else {
6321 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006322 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6323 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006324 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6325 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6326 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6327 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006328 }
6329
6330 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6331 return TemplateName(QTN);
6332}
6333
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006334/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6335/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6336TemplateName
6337ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006338 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006339 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6340 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6341
6342 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6343 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6344
6345 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006346 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6347 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006348
6349 if (QTN)
6350 return TemplateName(QTN);
6351
6352 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6353 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006354 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6355 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006356 } else {
6357 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006358 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6359 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006360
6361 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6362 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6363 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6364 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006365 }
6366
6367 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6368 return TemplateName(QTN);
6369}
6370
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006371TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006372ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6373 TemplateName replacement) const {
6374 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6375 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6376
6377 void *insertPos = 0;
6378 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6379 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6380
6381 if (!subst) {
6382 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6383 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6384 }
6385
6386 return TemplateName(subst);
6387}
6388
6389TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006390ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6391 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6392 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6393 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6394 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6395
6396 void *InsertPos = 0;
6397 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6398 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6399
6400 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006401 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006402 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6403 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6404 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6405 }
6406
6407 return TemplateName(Subst);
6408}
6409
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006410/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006411/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6412/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006413CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006414 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006415 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006416 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6417 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006418 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6419 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6420 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6421 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6422 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6423 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6424 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6425 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6426 }
6427
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006428 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006429}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006430
6431//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6432// Type Predicates.
6433//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6434
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006435/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6436/// garbage collection attribute.
6437///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006438Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006439 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006440 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6441
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006442 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006443 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6444
6445 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6446 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6447 // as __strong.
6448 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6449 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6450 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6451 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6452 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6453 } else {
6454 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6455 // pointer.
6456#ifndef NDEBUG
6457 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6458 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6459 CT = AT->getElementType();
6460 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6461#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006462 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006463 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006464}
6465
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006466//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6467// Type Compatibility Testing
6468//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006469
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006470/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006471/// compatible.
6472static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6473 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006474 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006475 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006476 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006477}
6478
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006479bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6480 QualType SecondVec) {
6481 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6482 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6483
6484 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6485 return true;
6486
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006487 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6488 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006489 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6490 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006491 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006492 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006493 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6494 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6495 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6496 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006497 return true;
6498
6499 return false;
6500}
6501
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006502//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6503// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6504//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6505
6506/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6507/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006508bool
6509ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6510 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006511 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006512 return true;
6513 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator PI = rProto->protocol_begin(),
6514 E = rProto->protocol_end(); PI != E; ++PI)
6515 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, *PI))
6516 return true;
6517 return false;
6518}
6519
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006520/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6521/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006522bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6523 QualType rhs) {
6524 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6525 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6526 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6527
6528 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6529 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6530 bool match = false;
6531 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6532 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6533 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6534 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6535 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6536 match = true;
6537 break;
6538 }
6539 }
6540 if (!match)
6541 return false;
6542 }
6543 return true;
6544}
6545
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006546/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6547/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6548bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6549 bool compare) {
6550 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006551 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006552 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6553 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006554 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006555 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6556 return true;
6557
6558 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006559 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006560
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006561 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006562
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006563 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006564 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006565 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6566 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6567 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6568 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6569 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6570 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6571 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006572 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006573 return false;
6574 }
6575 }
6576 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6577 return true;
6578 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006579 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006580 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6581 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6582 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6583 bool match = false;
6584
6585 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6586 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6587 // through its super class and categories.
6588 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6589 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6590 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6591 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6592 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6593 match = true;
6594 break;
6595 }
6596 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006597 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006598 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6599 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6600 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6601 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6602 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6603 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6604 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006605 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006606 match = true;
6607 break;
6608 }
6609 }
6610 }
6611 if (!match)
6612 return false;
6613 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006614
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006615 return true;
6616 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006617
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006618 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6619 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6620
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006621 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006622 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006623 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006624 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6625 E = lhsOPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6626 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6627 bool match = false;
6628
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006629 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006630 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6631 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006632 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6633 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006634 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6635 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6636 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6637 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6638 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6639 match = true;
6640 break;
6641 }
6642 }
6643 if (!match)
6644 return false;
6645 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006646
6647 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6648 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6649 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6650 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6651 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6652 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6653 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6654 // assume that it is mismatch.
6655 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6656 return false;
6657 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6658 LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6659 E = LHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6660 bool match = false;
6661 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = (*I);
6662 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6663 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6664 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6665 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6666 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6667 match = true;
6668 break;
6669 }
6670 }
6671 if (!match)
6672 return false;
6673 }
6674 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006675 return true;
6676 }
6677 return false;
6678}
6679
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006680/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006681/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6682/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6683///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006684bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6685 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006686 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6687 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6688
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006689 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006690 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6691 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006692 return true;
6693
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006694 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006695 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6696 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006697 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006698
6699 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6700 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6701 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6702
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006703 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6704 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006705 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006706
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006707 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006708}
6709
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006710/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006711/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006712/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6713/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6714/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6715bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6716 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006717 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6718 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006719 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006720 return true;
6721
6722 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6723 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6724 }
6725
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006726 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006727 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6728 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6729 false);
6730
6731 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6732 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6733 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6734 if (LHS != RHS) {
6735 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006736 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006737 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006738 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006739 }
6740 else
6741 return true;
6742 }
6743 return false;
6744}
6745
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006746/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6747/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6748/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6749/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6750static
6751void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6752 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6753 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006754 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006755
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006756 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6757 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6758 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6759 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006760
6761 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6762 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6763 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6764 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6765 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006766 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006767 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6768 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006769 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6770 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6771 }
6772
6773 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6774 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006775 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6776 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006777 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6778 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6779 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006780 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006781 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006782 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6783 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006784 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6785 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6786 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6787 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6788 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006789 }
6790}
6791
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006792/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6793/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6794/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6795/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6796QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006797 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6798 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6799 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6800 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6801 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6802 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006803 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006804 return QualType();
6805
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006806 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006807 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006808 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006809 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006810 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6811
6812 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6813 if (!Protocols.empty())
6814 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6815 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6816 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006817 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006818 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006819
6820 return QualType();
6821}
6822
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006823bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6824 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6825 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6826 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6827
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006828 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6829 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006830 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006831 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006832
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006833 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6834 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006835 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006836 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006837
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006838 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6839 // more detailed analysis is required.
6840 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6841 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6842 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6843 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006844 bool IsSuperClass =
6845 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6846 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006847 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6848 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6849 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6850 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6851 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006852 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006853 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6854 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6855 return false;
6856
6857 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6858 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
6859 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6860 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6861 ObjCProtocolDecl *LHSProto = (*LHSPI);
6862
6863 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6864 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6865 E = SuperClassInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6866 ObjCProtocolDecl *SuperClassProto = (*I);
6867 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6868 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6869 break;
6870 }
6871 }
6872 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6873 return false;
6874 }
6875 return true;
6876 }
6877 return false;
6878 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006879
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006880 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6881 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006882 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6883 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6884
6885 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6886 // are incompatible.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006887 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator RHSPI = RHS->qual_begin(),
6888 RHSPE = RHS->qual_end();
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006889 RHSPI != RHSPE; RHSPI++) {
6890 if ((*RHSPI)->lookupProtocolNamed((*LHSPI)->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006891 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006892 break;
6893 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006894 }
6895 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6896 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6897 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006898 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006899 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6900 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006901}
6902
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006903bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6904 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006905 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6906 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006907
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006908 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006909 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006910
6911 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6912 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006913}
6914
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006915bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6916 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6917 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6918 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6919}
6920
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006921/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006922/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006923/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006924/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006925bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6926 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006927 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006928 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6929
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006930 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006931}
6932
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006933bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006934 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006935}
6936
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006937bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6938 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6939}
6940
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006941/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6942/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6943/// QualType()
6944QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6945 bool OfBlockPointer,
6946 bool Unqualified) {
6947 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6948 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6949 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
6950 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
6951 itend = UD->field_end(); it != itend; ++it) {
Peter Collingbourne19b961d2010-12-02 21:00:06 +00006952 QualType ET = it->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006953 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6954 if (!MT.isNull())
6955 return MT;
6956 }
6957 }
6958 }
6959
6960 return QualType();
6961}
6962
6963/// mergeFunctionArgumentTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6964/// argument types
6965QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6966 bool OfBlockPointer,
6967 bool Unqualified) {
6968 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6969 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6970 // type is compatible with a union member
6971 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6972 Unqualified);
6973 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6974 return lmerge;
6975
6976 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6977 Unqualified);
6978 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6979 return rmerge;
6980
6981 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6982}
6983
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006984QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006985 bool OfBlockPointer,
6986 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006987 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6988 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006989 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6990 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006991 bool allLTypes = true;
6992 bool allRTypes = true;
6993
6994 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006995 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006996 if (OfBlockPointer) {
6997 QualType RHS = rbase->getResultType();
6998 QualType LHS = lbase->getResultType();
6999 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7000 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7001 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007002 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007003 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007004 else
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007005 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getResultType(), rbase->getResultType(), false,
7006 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007007 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007008
7009 if (Unqualified)
7010 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7011
7012 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getResultType());
7013 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getResultType());
7014 if (Unqualified) {
7015 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7016 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7017 }
7018
7019 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007020 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007021 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007022 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007023
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007024 // FIXME: double check this
7025 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7026 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7027 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007028 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7029 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007030
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007031 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007032 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007033 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007034
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007035 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007036 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7037 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007038 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7039 return QualType();
7040
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007041 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7042 return QualType();
7043
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007044 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7045 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007046
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007047 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7048 allLTypes = false;
7049 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7050 allRTypes = false;
7051
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007052 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007053
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007054 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007055 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7056 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007057 unsigned lproto_nargs = lproto->getNumArgs();
7058 unsigned rproto_nargs = rproto->getNumArgs();
7059
7060 // Compatible functions must have the same number of arguments
7061 if (lproto_nargs != rproto_nargs)
7062 return QualType();
7063
7064 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7065 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7066 return QualType();
7067
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007068 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7069 return QualType();
7070
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007071 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7072 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7073 return QualType();
7074
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007075 // Check argument compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007076 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007077 for (unsigned i = 0; i < lproto_nargs; i++) {
7078 QualType largtype = lproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7079 QualType rargtype = rproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007080 QualType argtype = mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(largtype, rargtype,
7081 OfBlockPointer,
7082 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007083 if (argtype.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007084
7085 if (Unqualified)
7086 argtype = argtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7087
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007088 types.push_back(argtype);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007089 if (Unqualified) {
7090 largtype = largtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7091 rargtype = rargtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7092 }
7093
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007094 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(largtype))
7095 allLTypes = false;
7096 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(rargtype))
7097 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007098 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007099
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007100 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7101 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007102
7103 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7104 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007105 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007106 }
7107
7108 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7109 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7110
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007111 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007112 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007113 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007114 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7115 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7116 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7117 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7118 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7119 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
7120 unsigned proto_nargs = proto->getNumArgs();
7121 for (unsigned i = 0; i < proto_nargs; ++i) {
7122 QualType argTy = proto->getArgType(i);
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007123
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007124 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007125 // to pass enum values.
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007126 if (const EnumType *Enum = argTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7127 argTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7128 if (argTy.isNull())
7129 return QualType();
7130 }
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007131
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007132 if (argTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7133 getCanonicalType(argTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7134 return QualType();
7135 }
7136
7137 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7138 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007139
7140 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7141 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007142 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getArgTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007143 }
7144
7145 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7146 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007147 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007148}
7149
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007150/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7151static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7152 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7153 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7154 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7155 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7156 // type.
7157 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7158 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7159 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7160 return other;
7161
7162 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7163 // integral type of the same size.
7164 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7165 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7166 return other;
7167
7168 return QualType();
7169}
7170
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007171QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007172 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007173 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007174 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7175 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7176 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007177 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7178 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007179 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7180 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007181
7182 if (Unqualified) {
7183 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7184 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7185 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007186
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007187 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7188 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7189
7190 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7191 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7192 return LHS;
7193
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007194 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007195 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7196 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007197 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7198 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7199 // mismatch.
7200 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007201 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7202 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007203 return QualType();
7204
7205 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7206 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7207 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7208 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7209 // qualified __strong.
7210 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7211 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7212 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7213
7214 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7215 return QualType();
7216
7217 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7218 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7219 }
7220 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7221 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7222 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007223 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007224 }
7225
7226 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007227
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007228 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7229 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007230
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007231 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7232 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7233 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7234 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007235
7236 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007237 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7238 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7239 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7240 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007241
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007242 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7243 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7244 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7245
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007246 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7247 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7248 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007249
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007250 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007251 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007252 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7253 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007254 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007255 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007256 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007257 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007258 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007259 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007260 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007261 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7262 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7263 return LHS;
7264 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7265 return RHS;
7266 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007267
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007268 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007269 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007270
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007271 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007272 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007273#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7274#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007275#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007276#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7277#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7278#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007279 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007280
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007281 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007282 case Type::LValueReference:
7283 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007284 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007285 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007286
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007287 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007288 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7289 case Type::VariableArray:
7290 case Type::FunctionProto:
7291 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007292 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007293
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007294 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007295 {
7296 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007297 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7298 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007299 if (Unqualified) {
7300 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7301 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7302 }
7303 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7304 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007305 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007306 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007307 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007308 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007309 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007310 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7311 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007312 case Type::BlockPointer:
7313 {
7314 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007315 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7316 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007317 if (Unqualified) {
7318 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7319 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7320 }
7321 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7322 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007323 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7324 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7325 return LHS;
7326 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7327 return RHS;
7328 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7329 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007330 case Type::Atomic:
7331 {
7332 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7333 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7334 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7335 if (Unqualified) {
7336 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7337 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7338 }
7339 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7340 Unqualified);
7341 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7342 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7343 return LHS;
7344 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7345 return RHS;
7346 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7347 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007348 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007349 {
7350 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7351 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7352 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7353 return QualType();
7354
7355 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7356 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007357 if (Unqualified) {
7358 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7359 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7360 }
7361
7362 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007363 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007364 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7365 return LHS;
7366 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7367 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007368 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7369 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7370 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7371 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007372 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7373 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007374 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7375 return LHS;
7376 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7377 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007378 if (LVAT) {
7379 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7380 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7381 // has to be different.
7382 return LHS;
7383 }
7384 if (RVAT) {
7385 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7386 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7387 // has to be different.
7388 return RHS;
7389 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007390 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7391 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007392 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7393 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007394 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007395 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007396 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007397 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007398 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007399 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007400 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007401 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007402 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007403 case Type::Complex:
7404 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7405 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007406 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007407 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007408 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7409 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007410 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007411 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007412 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7413 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007414 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7415 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007416 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7417 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7418 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007419 return LHS;
7420
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007421 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007422 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007423 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007424 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7425 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7426 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007427 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7428 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007429 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007430 return QualType();
7431 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007432 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7433 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007434 return LHS;
7435
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007436 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007437 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007438 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007439
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007440 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007441}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007442
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007443bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7444 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7445 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7446 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs() !=
7447 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs())
7448 return false;
7449 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7450 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7451 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7452 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7453 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments && ToEPI.ConsumedArguments)
7454 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
7455 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7456 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx] !=
7457 ToEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx])
7458 return false;
7459 }
7460 return true;
7461}
7462
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007463/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7464/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7465/// return types.
7466QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7467 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7468 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7469 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7470 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7471 return LHS;
7472 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7473 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7474 return QualType();
7475 QualType OldReturnType =
7476 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7477 QualType NewReturnType =
7478 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7479 QualType ResReturnType =
7480 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7481 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7482 return QualType();
7483 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7484 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7485 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7486 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7487 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007488 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7489 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007490 QualType ResultType =
7491 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007492 return ResultType;
7493 }
7494 }
7495 return QualType();
7496 }
7497
7498 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7499 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7500 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7501 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7502 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7503 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7504 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7505 return QualType();
7506
7507 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7508 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7509 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7510 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7511 // qualified __strong.
7512 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7513 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7514 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7515
7516 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7517 return QualType();
7518
7519 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7520 return LHS;
7521 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7522 return RHS;
7523 return QualType();
7524 }
7525
7526 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7527 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7528 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7529 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7530 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7531 return LHS;
7532 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7533 return RHS;
7534 }
7535 return QualType();
7536}
7537
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007538//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007539// Integer Predicates
7540//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007541
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007542unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007543 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007544 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007545 if (T->isBooleanType())
7546 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007547 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007548 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7549}
7550
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007551QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007552 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007553
7554 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7555 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7556 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007557 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007558
7559 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7560 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007561 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007562
7563 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7564 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007565 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7566 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7567 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7568 return UnsignedCharTy;
7569 case BuiltinType::Short:
7570 return UnsignedShortTy;
7571 case BuiltinType::Int:
7572 return UnsignedIntTy;
7573 case BuiltinType::Long:
7574 return UnsignedLongTy;
7575 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7576 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007577 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7578 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007579 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007580 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007581 }
7582}
7583
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007584ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7585
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007586void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7587 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007588
7589//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7590// Builtin Type Computation
7591//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7592
7593/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007594/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7595/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7596/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7597/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007598///
7599/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7600/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007601static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007602 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007603 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007604 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007605 // Modifiers.
7606 int HowLong = 0;
7607 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007608 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007609
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007610 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007611 bool Done = false;
7612 while (!Done) {
7613 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007614 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007615 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007616 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007617 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007618 case 'S':
7619 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7620 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7621 Signed = true;
7622 break;
7623 case 'U':
7624 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7625 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7626 Unsigned = true;
7627 break;
7628 case 'L':
7629 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7630 ++HowLong;
7631 break;
7632 }
7633 }
7634
7635 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007636
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007637 // Read the base type.
7638 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007639 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007640 case 'v':
7641 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7642 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7643 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7644 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007645 case 'h':
7646 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7647 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7648 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7649 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007650 case 'f':
7651 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7652 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7653 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7654 break;
7655 case 'd':
7656 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7657 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7658 if (HowLong)
7659 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7660 else
7661 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7662 break;
7663 case 's':
7664 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7665 if (Unsigned)
7666 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7667 else
7668 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7669 break;
7670 case 'i':
7671 if (HowLong == 3)
7672 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7673 else if (HowLong == 2)
7674 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7675 else if (HowLong == 1)
7676 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7677 else
7678 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7679 break;
7680 case 'c':
7681 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7682 if (Signed)
7683 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7684 else if (Unsigned)
7685 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7686 else
7687 Type = Context.CharTy;
7688 break;
7689 case 'b': // boolean
7690 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7691 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7692 break;
7693 case 'z': // size_t.
7694 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7695 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7696 break;
7697 case 'F':
7698 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7699 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007700 case 'G':
7701 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7702 break;
7703 case 'H':
7704 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7705 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007706 case 'M':
7707 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7708 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007709 case 'a':
7710 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7711 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7712 break;
7713 case 'A':
7714 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7715 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7716 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7717 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7718 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7719 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7720 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7721 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7722 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7723 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007724 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007725 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007726 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007727 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007728 break;
7729 case 'V': {
7730 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007731 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7732 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007733 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007734
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007735 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7736 RequiresICE, false);
7737 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007738
7739 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007740 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007741 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007742 break;
7743 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007744 case 'E': {
7745 char *End;
7746
7747 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7748 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7749
7750 Str = End;
7751
7752 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7753 false);
7754 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7755 break;
7756 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007757 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007758 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7759 false);
7760 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007761 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7762 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007763 }
7764 case 'Y' : {
7765 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7766 break;
7767 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007768 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007769 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7770 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007771 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007772 return QualType();
7773 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007774 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007775 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007776 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007777 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007778 else
7779 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7780
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007781 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007782 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007783 return QualType();
7784 }
7785 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007786 case 'K':
7787 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7788 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7789
7790 if (Type.isNull()) {
7791 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7792 return QualType();
7793 }
7794 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007795 case 'p':
7796 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7797 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007798 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007799
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007800 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7801 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007802 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007803 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007804 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7805 case '*':
7806 case '&': {
7807 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7808 // qualified with an address space.
7809 char *End;
7810 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7811 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7812 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7813 Str = End;
7814 }
7815 if (c == '*')
7816 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7817 else
7818 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7819 break;
7820 }
7821 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7822 case 'C':
7823 Type = Type.withConst();
7824 break;
7825 case 'D':
7826 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7827 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007828 case 'R':
7829 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7830 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007831 }
7832 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007833
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007834 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007835 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007836
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007837 return Type;
7838}
7839
7840/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007841QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007842 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007843 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007844 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007845
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007846 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007847
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007848 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007849 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007850 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7851 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007852 if (Error != GE_None)
7853 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007854
7855 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7856
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007857 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007858 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007859 if (Error != GE_None)
7860 return QualType();
7861
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007862 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7863 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7864 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7865 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7866
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007867 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7868 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7869 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007870
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007871 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7872 }
7873
7874 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7875 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7876
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007877 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007878 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7879
7880 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7881
7882 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7883 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7884 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007885
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007886 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007887 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7888 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007889
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007890 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007891}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007892
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007893GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007894 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007895 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007896
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007897 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7898 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7899 case TSK_Undeclared:
7900 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7901 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7902 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007903
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007904 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7905 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
7906
7907 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7908 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7909 External = GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
7910 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007911 }
7912
7913 if (!FD->isInlined())
7914 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007915
7916 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode) ||
7917 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007918 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7919 // externally visible.
7920 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7921 return External;
7922
7923 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
7924 return GVA_C99Inline;
7925 }
7926
7927 // C++0x [temp.explicit]p9:
7928 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7929 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7930 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7931 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7932 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
7933 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
7934 == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration)
7935 return GVA_C99Inline;
7936
7937 return GVA_CXXInline;
7938}
7939
7940GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007941 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7942 return GVA_Internal;
7943
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007944 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007945 case TSK_Undeclared:
7946 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7947 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007948
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007949 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7950 llvm_unreachable("Variable should not be instantiated");
7951 // Fall through to treat this like any other instantiation.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007952
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007953 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7954 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007955
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007956 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7957 return GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007958 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007959
7960 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007961}
7962
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007963bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007964 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7965 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7966 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007967 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7968 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7969 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7970 return false;
7971 } else
7972 return false;
7973
7974 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7975 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007976 return false;
7977
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007978 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7979 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7980 return false;
7981
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007982 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7983 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7984 return true;
7985
7986 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7987 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007988 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007989 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007990
7991 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7992 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7993 return true;
7994
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007995 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7996 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7997 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7998 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7999 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8000 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8001 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8002 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8003 return true;
8004 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008005 }
8006 }
8007
8008 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8009
8010 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8011 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8012 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
8013 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_C99Inline ||
Anton Yartsev79de4d42012-02-02 06:06:34 +00008014 Linkage == GVA_CXXInline || Linkage == GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008015 return false;
8016 return true;
8017 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008018
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008019 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8020 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8021
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008022 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
8023 return false;
8024
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008025 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008026 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008027 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
8028 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008029
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008030 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8031 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8032 return true;
8033
8034 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8035 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
8036 return true;
8037
8038 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008039}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008040
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008041CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8042 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008043 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008044 if (IsCXXMethod)
8045 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008046
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008047 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008048}
8049
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008050bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008051 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8052 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8053}
8054
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008055MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008056 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008057 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008058 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8059 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8060 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008061 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008062 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008063 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008064 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008065 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008066}
8067
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008068CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008069
8070size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008071 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8072 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8073 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8074 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8075 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8076 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8077 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8078 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8079 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8080 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8081 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8082 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8083 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8084 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008085}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008086
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008087/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8088/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8089/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8090/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8091QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8092 unsigned Signed) const {
8093 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8094 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8095 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8096 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8097 return QualTy;
8098}
8099
8100/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8101/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8102/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8103QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8104 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8105 switch (Ty) {
8106 case TargetInfo::Float:
8107 return FloatTy;
8108 case TargetInfo::Double:
8109 return DoubleTy;
8110 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8111 return LongDoubleTy;
8112 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8113 return QualType();
8114 }
8115
8116 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8117}
8118
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008119void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8120 if (Number > 1)
8121 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008122}
8123
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008124unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8125 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8126 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8127 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008128}
8129
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008130MangleNumberingContext &
8131ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008132 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8133 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8134 if (!MCtx)
8135 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8136 return *MCtx;
8137}
8138
8139MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8140 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008141}
8142
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008143void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8144 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8145}
8146
8147unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8148 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8149 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8150 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8151 return I->second;
8152}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008153
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008154APValue *
8155ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8156 bool MayCreate) {
8157 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8158 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8159 if (MayCreate)
8160 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8161
8162 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8163 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
8164 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? 0 : &I->second;
8165}
8166
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008167bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8168 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8169 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8170 return false;
8171
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008172 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8173 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8174 return false;
8175
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008176 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8177 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8178 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8179 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8180 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8181 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8182 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8183}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008184
8185namespace {
8186
8187 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8188 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8189 ///
8190 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8191 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8192 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8193 ///
8194 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8195 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8196
8197 public:
8198 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8199 ///
8200 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8201 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8202 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8203 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8204 return Visitor.Parents;
8205 }
8206
8207 private:
8208 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8209
8210 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8211 }
8212
8213 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8214 return true;
8215 }
8216 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8217 return true;
8218 }
8219 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8220 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8221 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8222 return false;
8223 }
8224
8225 template <typename T>
8226 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8227 if (Node == NULL)
8228 return true;
8229 if (ParentStack.size() > 0)
8230 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, for example
8231 // when we visit all subexpressions of template instantiations; this is
8232 // suboptimal, bug benign: the only way to visit those is with
8233 // hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create new matches.
8234 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8235 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8236 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8237 // do not have pointer identity.
8238 (*Parents)[Node].push_back(ParentStack.back());
8239 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8240 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8241 ParentStack.pop_back();
8242 return Result;
8243 }
8244
8245 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8246 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8247 }
8248
8249 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8250 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8251 }
8252
8253 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8254 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8255
8256 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8257 };
8258
8259} // end namespace
8260
8261ASTContext::ParentVector
8262ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8263 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8264 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8265 "used in the parent map.");
8266 if (!AllParents) {
8267 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8268 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8269 AllParents.reset(
8270 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8271 }
8272 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8273 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8274 return ParentVector();
8275 }
8276 return I->second;
8277}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008278
8279bool
8280ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8281 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8282 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8283 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8284 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8285 return false;
8286 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8287 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8288 return false;
8289 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getResultType(),
8290 MethodImpl->getResultType()))
8291 return false;
8292
8293 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8294 return false;
8295
8296 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8297 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8298 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8299 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8300 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8301 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8302 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8303 return false;
8304 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8305 return false;
8306 }
8307 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8308
8309}